xref: /openbsd/gnu/usr.bin/perl/lib/perl5db.pl (revision 09467b48)
1
2=head1 NAME
3
4perl5db.pl - the perl debugger
5
6=head1 SYNOPSIS
7
8    perl -d  your_Perl_script
9
10=head1 DESCRIPTION
11
12C<perl5db.pl> is the perl debugger. It is loaded automatically by Perl when
13you invoke a script with C<perl -d>. This documentation tries to outline the
14structure and services provided by C<perl5db.pl>, and to describe how you
15can use them.
16
17=head1 GENERAL NOTES
18
19The debugger can look pretty forbidding to many Perl programmers. There are
20a number of reasons for this, many stemming out of the debugger's history.
21
22When the debugger was first written, Perl didn't have a lot of its nicer
23features - no references, no lexical variables, no closures, no object-oriented
24programming. So a lot of the things one would normally have done using such
25features was done using global variables, globs and the C<local()> operator
26in creative ways.
27
28Some of these have survived into the current debugger; a few of the more
29interesting and still-useful idioms are noted in this section, along with notes
30on the comments themselves.
31
32=head2 Why not use more lexicals?
33
34Experienced Perl programmers will note that the debugger code tends to use
35mostly package globals rather than lexically-scoped variables. This is done
36to allow a significant amount of control of the debugger from outside the
37debugger itself.
38
39Unfortunately, though the variables are accessible, they're not well
40documented, so it's generally been a decision that hasn't made a lot of
41difference to most users. Where appropriate, comments have been added to
42make variables more accessible and usable, with the understanding that these
43I<are> debugger internals, and are therefore subject to change. Future
44development should probably attempt to replace the globals with a well-defined
45API, but for now, the variables are what we've got.
46
47=head2 Automated variable stacking via C<local()>
48
49As you may recall from reading C<perlfunc>, the C<local()> operator makes a
50temporary copy of a variable in the current scope. When the scope ends, the
51old copy is restored. This is often used in the debugger to handle the
52automatic stacking of variables during recursive calls:
53
54     sub foo {
55        local $some_global++;
56
57        # Do some stuff, then ...
58        return;
59     }
60
61What happens is that on entry to the subroutine, C<$some_global> is localized,
62then altered. When the subroutine returns, Perl automatically undoes the
63localization, restoring the previous value. Voila, automatic stack management.
64
65The debugger uses this trick a I<lot>. Of particular note is C<DB::eval>,
66which lets the debugger get control inside of C<eval>'ed code. The debugger
67localizes a saved copy of C<$@> inside the subroutine, which allows it to
68keep C<$@> safe until it C<DB::eval> returns, at which point the previous
69value of C<$@> is restored. This makes it simple (well, I<simpler>) to keep
70track of C<$@> inside C<eval>s which C<eval> other C<eval's>.
71
72In any case, watch for this pattern. It occurs fairly often.
73
74=head2 The C<^> trick
75
76This is used to cleverly reverse the sense of a logical test depending on
77the value of an auxiliary variable. For instance, the debugger's C<S>
78(search for subroutines by pattern) allows you to negate the pattern
79like this:
80
81   # Find all non-'foo' subs:
82   S !/foo/
83
84Boolean algebra states that the truth table for XOR looks like this:
85
86=over 4
87
88=item * 0 ^ 0 = 0
89
90(! not present and no match) --> false, don't print
91
92=item * 0 ^ 1 = 1
93
94(! not present and matches) --> true, print
95
96=item * 1 ^ 0 = 1
97
98(! present and no match) --> true, print
99
100=item * 1 ^ 1 = 0
101
102(! present and matches) --> false, don't print
103
104=back
105
106As you can see, the first pair applies when C<!> isn't supplied, and
107the second pair applies when it is. The XOR simply allows us to
108compact a more complicated if-then-elseif-else into a more elegant
109(but perhaps overly clever) single test. After all, it needed this
110explanation...
111
112=head2 FLAGS, FLAGS, FLAGS
113
114There is a certain C programming legacy in the debugger. Some variables,
115such as C<$single>, C<$trace>, and C<$frame>, have I<magical> values composed
116of 1, 2, 4, etc. (powers of 2) OR'ed together. This allows several pieces
117of state to be stored independently in a single scalar.
118
119A test like
120
121    if ($scalar & 4) ...
122
123is checking to see if the appropriate bit is on. Since each bit can be
124"addressed" independently in this way, C<$scalar> is acting sort of like
125an array of bits. Obviously, since the contents of C<$scalar> are just a
126bit-pattern, we can save and restore it easily (it will just look like
127a number).
128
129The problem, is of course, that this tends to leave magic numbers scattered
130all over your program whenever a bit is set, cleared, or checked. So why do
131it?
132
133=over 4
134
135=item *
136
137First, doing an arithmetical or bitwise operation on a scalar is
138just about the fastest thing you can do in Perl: C<use constant> actually
139creates a subroutine call, and array and hash lookups are much slower. Is
140this over-optimization at the expense of readability? Possibly, but the
141debugger accesses these  variables a I<lot>. Any rewrite of the code will
142probably have to benchmark alternate implementations and see which is the
143best balance of readability and speed, and then document how it actually
144works.
145
146=item *
147
148Second, it's very easy to serialize a scalar number. This is done in
149the restart code; the debugger state variables are saved in C<%ENV> and then
150restored when the debugger is restarted. Having them be just numbers makes
151this trivial.
152
153=item *
154
155Third, some of these variables are being shared with the Perl core
156smack in the middle of the interpreter's execution loop. It's much faster for
157a C program (like the interpreter) to check a bit in a scalar than to access
158several different variables (or a Perl array).
159
160=back
161
162=head2 What are those C<XXX> comments for?
163
164Any comment containing C<XXX> means that the comment is either somewhat
165speculative - it's not exactly clear what a given variable or chunk of
166code is doing, or that it is incomplete - the basics may be clear, but the
167subtleties are not completely documented.
168
169Send in a patch if you can clear up, fill out, or clarify an C<XXX>.
170
171=head1 DATA STRUCTURES MAINTAINED BY CORE
172
173There are a number of special data structures provided to the debugger by
174the Perl interpreter.
175
176The array C<@{$main::{'_<'.$filename}}> (aliased locally to C<@dbline>
177via glob assignment) contains the text from C<$filename>, with each
178element corresponding to a single line of C<$filename>. Additionally,
179breakable lines will be dualvars with the numeric component being the
180memory address of a COP node. Non-breakable lines are dualvar to 0.
181
182The hash C<%{'_<'.$filename}> (aliased locally to C<%dbline> via glob
183assignment) contains breakpoints and actions.  The keys are line numbers;
184you can set individual values, but not the whole hash. The Perl interpreter
185uses this hash to determine where breakpoints have been set. Any true value is
186considered to be a breakpoint; C<perl5db.pl> uses C<$break_condition\0$action>.
187Values are magical in numeric context: 1 if the line is breakable, 0 if not.
188
189The scalar C<${"_<$filename"}> simply contains the string C<$filename>.
190This is also the case for evaluated strings that contain subroutines, or
191which are currently being executed.  The $filename for C<eval>ed strings looks
192like C<(eval 34)>.
193
194=head1 DEBUGGER STARTUP
195
196When C<perl5db.pl> starts, it reads an rcfile (C<perl5db.ini> for
197non-interactive sessions, C<.perldb> for interactive ones) that can set a number
198of options. In addition, this file may define a subroutine C<&afterinit>
199that will be executed (in the debugger's context) after the debugger has
200initialized itself.
201
202Next, it checks the C<PERLDB_OPTS> environment variable and treats its
203contents as the argument of a C<o> command in the debugger.
204
205=head2 STARTUP-ONLY OPTIONS
206
207The following options can only be specified at startup.
208To set them in your rcfile, add a call to
209C<&parse_options("optionName=new_value")>.
210
211=over 4
212
213=item * TTY
214
215the TTY to use for debugging i/o.
216
217=item * noTTY
218
219if set, goes in NonStop mode.  On interrupt, if TTY is not set,
220uses the value of noTTY or F<$HOME/.perldbtty$$> to find TTY using
221Term::Rendezvous.  Current variant is to have the name of TTY in this
222file.
223
224=item * ReadLine
225
226if false, a dummy ReadLine is used, so you can debug
227ReadLine applications.
228
229=item * NonStop
230
231if true, no i/o is performed until interrupt.
232
233=item * LineInfo
234
235file or pipe to print line number info to.  If it is a
236pipe, a short "emacs like" message is used.
237
238=item * RemotePort
239
240host:port to connect to on remote host for remote debugging.
241
242=item * HistFile
243
244file to store session history to. There is no default and so no
245history file is written unless this variable is explicitly set.
246
247=item * HistSize
248
249number of commands to store to the file specified in C<HistFile>.
250Default is 100.
251
252=back
253
254=head3 SAMPLE RCFILE
255
256 &parse_options("NonStop=1 LineInfo=db.out");
257  sub afterinit { $trace = 1; }
258
259The script will run without human intervention, putting trace
260information into C<db.out>.  (If you interrupt it, you had better
261reset C<LineInfo> to something I<interactive>!)
262
263=head1 INTERNALS DESCRIPTION
264
265=head2 DEBUGGER INTERFACE VARIABLES
266
267Perl supplies the values for C<%sub>.  It effectively inserts
268a C<&DB::DB();> in front of each place that can have a
269breakpoint. At each subroutine call, it calls C<&DB::sub> with
270C<$DB::sub> set to the called subroutine. It also inserts a C<BEGIN
271{require 'perl5db.pl'}> before the first line.
272
273After each C<require>d file is compiled, but before it is executed, a
274call to C<&DB::postponed($main::{'_<'.$filename})> is done. C<$filename>
275is the expanded name of the C<require>d file (as found via C<%INC>).
276
277=head3 IMPORTANT INTERNAL VARIABLES
278
279=head4 C<$CreateTTY>
280
281Used to control when the debugger will attempt to acquire another TTY to be
282used for input.
283
284=over
285
286=item * 1 -  on C<fork()>
287
288=item * 2 - debugger is started inside debugger
289
290=item * 4 -  on startup
291
292=back
293
294=head4 C<$doret>
295
296The value -2 indicates that no return value should be printed.
297Any other positive value causes C<DB::sub> to print return values.
298
299=head4 C<$evalarg>
300
301The item to be eval'ed by C<DB::eval>. Used to prevent messing with the current
302contents of C<@_> when C<DB::eval> is called.
303
304=head4 C<$frame>
305
306Determines what messages (if any) will get printed when a subroutine (or eval)
307is entered or exited.
308
309=over 4
310
311=item * 0 -  No enter/exit messages
312
313=item * 1 - Print I<entering> messages on subroutine entry
314
315=item * 2 - Adds exit messages on subroutine exit. If no other flag is on, acts like 1+2.
316
317=item * 4 - Extended messages: C<< <in|out> I<context>=I<fully-qualified sub name> from I<file>:I<line> >>. If no other flag is on, acts like 1+4.
318
319=item * 8 - Adds parameter information to messages, and overloaded stringify and tied FETCH is enabled on the printed arguments. Ignored if C<4> is not on.
320
321=item * 16 - Adds C<I<context> return from I<subname>: I<value>> messages on subroutine/eval exit. Ignored if C<4> is not on.
322
323=back
324
325To get everything, use C<$frame=30> (or C<o f=30> as a debugger command).
326The debugger internally juggles the value of C<$frame> during execution to
327protect external modules that the debugger uses from getting traced.
328
329=head4 C<$level>
330
331Tracks current debugger nesting level. Used to figure out how many
332C<E<lt>E<gt>> pairs to surround the line number with when the debugger
333outputs a prompt. Also used to help determine if the program has finished
334during command parsing.
335
336=head4 C<$onetimeDump>
337
338Controls what (if anything) C<DB::eval()> will print after evaluating an
339expression.
340
341=over 4
342
343=item * C<undef> - don't print anything
344
345=item * C<dump> - use C<dumpvar.pl> to display the value returned
346
347=item * C<methods> - print the methods callable on the first item returned
348
349=back
350
351=head4 C<$onetimeDumpDepth>
352
353Controls how far down C<dumpvar.pl> will go before printing C<...> while
354dumping a structure. Numeric. If C<undef>, print all levels.
355
356=head4 C<$signal>
357
358Used to track whether or not an C<INT> signal has been detected. C<DB::DB()>,
359which is called before every statement, checks this and puts the user into
360command mode if it finds C<$signal> set to a true value.
361
362=head4 C<$single>
363
364Controls behavior during single-stepping. Stacked in C<@stack> on entry to
365each subroutine; popped again at the end of each subroutine.
366
367=over 4
368
369=item * 0 - run continuously.
370
371=item * 1 - single-step, go into subs. The C<s> command.
372
373=item * 2 - single-step, don't go into subs. The C<n> command.
374
375=item * 4 - print current sub depth (turned on to force this when C<too much
376recursion> occurs.
377
378=back
379
380=head4 C<$trace>
381
382Controls the output of trace information.
383
384=over 4
385
386=item * 1 - The C<t> command was entered to turn on tracing (every line executed is printed)
387
388=item * 2 - watch expressions are active
389
390=item * 4 - user defined a C<watchfunction()> in C<afterinit()>
391
392=back
393
394=head4 C<$slave_editor>
395
3961 if C<LINEINFO> was directed to a pipe; 0 otherwise.
397
398=head4 C<@cmdfhs>
399
400Stack of filehandles that C<DB::readline()> will read commands from.
401Manipulated by the debugger's C<source> command and C<DB::readline()> itself.
402
403=head4 C<@dbline>
404
405Local alias to the magical line array, C<@{$main::{'_<'.$filename}}> ,
406supplied by the Perl interpreter to the debugger. Contains the source.
407
408=head4 C<@old_watch>
409
410Previous values of watch expressions. First set when the expression is
411entered; reset whenever the watch expression changes.
412
413=head4 C<@saved>
414
415Saves important globals (C<$@>, C<$!>, C<$^E>, C<$,>, C<$/>, C<$\>, C<$^W>)
416so that the debugger can substitute safe values while it's running, and
417restore them when it returns control.
418
419=head4 C<@stack>
420
421Saves the current value of C<$single> on entry to a subroutine.
422Manipulated by the C<c> command to turn off tracing in all subs above the
423current one.
424
425=head4 C<@to_watch>
426
427The 'watch' expressions: to be evaluated before each line is executed.
428
429=head4 C<@typeahead>
430
431The typeahead buffer, used by C<DB::readline>.
432
433=head4 C<%alias>
434
435Command aliases. Stored as character strings to be substituted for a command
436entered.
437
438=head4 C<%break_on_load>
439
440Keys are file names, values are 1 (break when this file is loaded) or undef
441(don't break when it is loaded).
442
443=head4 C<%dbline>
444
445Keys are line numbers, values are C<condition\0action>. If used in numeric
446context, values are 0 if not breakable, 1 if breakable, no matter what is
447in the actual hash entry.
448
449=head4 C<%had_breakpoints>
450
451Keys are file names; values are bitfields:
452
453=over 4
454
455=item * 1 - file has a breakpoint in it.
456
457=item * 2 - file has an action in it.
458
459=back
460
461A zero or undefined value means this file has neither.
462
463=head4 C<%option>
464
465Stores the debugger options. These are character string values.
466
467=head4 C<%postponed>
468
469Saves breakpoints for code that hasn't been compiled yet.
470Keys are subroutine names, values are:
471
472=over 4
473
474=item * C<compile> - break when this sub is compiled
475
476=item * C<< break +0 if <condition> >> - break (conditionally) at the start of this routine. The condition will be '1' if no condition was specified.
477
478=back
479
480=head4 C<%postponed_file>
481
482This hash keeps track of breakpoints that need to be set for files that have
483not yet been compiled. Keys are filenames; values are references to hashes.
484Each of these hashes is keyed by line number, and its values are breakpoint
485definitions (C<condition\0action>).
486
487=head1 DEBUGGER INITIALIZATION
488
489The debugger's initialization actually jumps all over the place inside this
490package. This is because there are several BEGIN blocks (which of course
491execute immediately) spread through the code. Why is that?
492
493The debugger needs to be able to change some things and set some things up
494before the debugger code is compiled; most notably, the C<$deep> variable that
495C<DB::sub> uses to tell when a program has recursed deeply. In addition, the
496debugger has to turn off warnings while the debugger code is compiled, but then
497restore them to their original setting before the program being debugged begins
498executing.
499
500The first C<BEGIN> block simply turns off warnings by saving the current
501setting of C<$^W> and then setting it to zero. The second one initializes
502the debugger variables that are needed before the debugger begins executing.
503The third one puts C<$^X> back to its former value.
504
505We'll detail the second C<BEGIN> block later; just remember that if you need
506to initialize something before the debugger starts really executing, that's
507where it has to go.
508
509=cut
510
511package DB;
512
513use strict;
514
515use Cwd ();
516
517my $_initial_cwd;
518
519BEGIN {eval 'use IO::Handle'}; # Needed for flush only? breaks under miniperl
520
521BEGIN {
522    require feature;
523    $^V =~ /^v(\d+\.\d+)/;
524    feature->import(":$1");
525    $_initial_cwd = Cwd::getcwd();
526}
527
528# Debugger for Perl 5.00x; perl5db.pl patch level:
529use vars qw($VERSION $header);
530
531# bump to X.XX in blead, only use X.XX_XX in maint
532$VERSION = '1.55';
533
534$header = "perl5db.pl version $VERSION";
535
536=head1 DEBUGGER ROUTINES
537
538=head2 C<DB::eval()>
539
540This function replaces straight C<eval()> inside the debugger; it simplifies
541the process of evaluating code in the user's context.
542
543The code to be evaluated is passed via the package global variable
544C<$DB::evalarg>; this is done to avoid fiddling with the contents of C<@_>.
545
546Before we do the C<eval()>, we preserve the current settings of C<$trace>,
547C<$single>, C<$^D> and C<$usercontext>.  The latter contains the
548preserved values of C<$@>, C<$!>, C<$^E>, C<$,>, C<$/>, C<$\>, C<$^W> and the
549user's current package, grabbed when C<DB::DB> got control.  This causes the
550proper context to be used when the eval is actually done.  Afterward, we
551restore C<$trace>, C<$single>, and C<$^D>.
552
553Next we need to handle C<$@> without getting confused. We save C<$@> in a
554local lexical, localize C<$saved[0]> (which is where C<save()> will put
555C<$@>), and then call C<save()> to capture C<$@>, C<$!>, C<$^E>, C<$,>,
556C<$/>, C<$\>, and C<$^W>) and set C<$,>, C<$/>, C<$\>, and C<$^W> to values
557considered sane by the debugger. If there was an C<eval()> error, we print
558it on the debugger's output. If C<$onetimedump> is defined, we call
559C<dumpit> if it's set to 'dump', or C<methods> if it's set to
560'methods'. Setting it to something else causes the debugger to do the eval
561but not print the result - handy if you want to do something else with it
562(the "watch expressions" code does this to get the value of the watch
563expression but not show it unless it matters).
564
565In any case, we then return the list of output from C<eval> to the caller,
566and unwinding restores the former version of C<$@> in C<@saved> as well
567(the localization of C<$saved[0]> goes away at the end of this scope).
568
569=head3 Parameters and variables influencing execution of DB::eval()
570
571C<DB::eval> isn't parameterized in the standard way; this is to keep the
572debugger's calls to C<DB::eval()> from mucking with C<@_>, among other things.
573The variables listed below influence C<DB::eval()>'s execution directly.
574
575=over 4
576
577=item C<$evalarg> - the thing to actually be eval'ed
578
579=item C<$trace> - Current state of execution tracing
580
581=item C<$single> - Current state of single-stepping
582
583=item C<$onetimeDump> - what is to be displayed after the evaluation
584
585=item C<$onetimeDumpDepth> - how deep C<dumpit()> should go when dumping results
586
587=back
588
589The following variables are altered by C<DB::eval()> during its execution. They
590are "stacked" via C<local()>, enabling recursive calls to C<DB::eval()>.
591
592=over 4
593
594=item C<@res> - used to capture output from actual C<eval>.
595
596=item C<$otrace> - saved value of C<$trace>.
597
598=item C<$osingle> - saved value of C<$single>.
599
600=item C<$od> - saved value of C<$^D>.
601
602=item C<$saved[0]> - saved value of C<$@>.
603
604=item $\ - for output of C<$@> if there is an evaluation error.
605
606=back
607
608=head3 The problem of lexicals
609
610The context of C<DB::eval()> presents us with some problems. Obviously,
611we want to be 'sandboxed' away from the debugger's internals when we do
612the eval, but we need some way to control how punctuation variables and
613debugger globals are used.
614
615We can't use local, because the code inside C<DB::eval> can see localized
616variables; and we can't use C<my> either for the same reason. The code
617in this routine compromises and uses C<my>.
618
619After this routine is over, we don't have user code executing in the debugger's
620context, so we can use C<my> freely.
621
622=cut
623
624############################################## Begin lexical danger zone
625
626# 'my' variables used here could leak into (that is, be visible in)
627# the context that the code being evaluated is executing in. This means that
628# the code could modify the debugger's variables.
629#
630# Fiddling with the debugger's context could be Bad. We insulate things as
631# much as we can.
632
633use vars qw(
634    @args
635    %break_on_load
636    $CommandSet
637    $CreateTTY
638    $DBGR
639    @dbline
640    $dbline
641    %dbline
642    $dieLevel
643    $filename
644    $histfile
645    $histsize
646    $IN
647    $inhibit_exit
648    @ini_INC
649    $ini_warn
650    $maxtrace
651    $od
652    @options
653    $osingle
654    $otrace
655    $pager
656    $post
657    %postponed
658    $prc
659    $pre
660    $pretype
661    $psh
662    @RememberOnROptions
663    $remoteport
664    @res
665    $rl
666    @saved
667    $signalLevel
668    $sub
669    $term
670    $usercontext
671    $warnLevel
672);
673
674our (
675    @cmdfhs,
676    $evalarg,
677    $frame,
678    $hist,
679    $ImmediateStop,
680    $line,
681    $onetimeDump,
682    $onetimedumpDepth,
683    %option,
684    $OUT,
685    $packname,
686    $signal,
687    $single,
688    $start,
689    %sub,
690    $subname,
691    $trace,
692    $window,
693);
694
695# Used to save @ARGV and extract any debugger-related flags.
696use vars qw(@ARGS);
697
698# Used to prevent multiple entries to diesignal()
699# (if for instance diesignal() itself dies)
700use vars qw($panic);
701
702# Used to prevent the debugger from running nonstop
703# after a restart
704our ($second_time);
705
706sub _calc_usercontext {
707    my ($package) = @_;
708
709    # Cancel strict completely for the evaluated code, so the code
710    # the user evaluates won't be affected by it. (Shlomi Fish)
711    return 'no strict; ($@, $!, $^E, $,, $/, $\, $^W) = @DB::saved;'
712    . "package $package;";    # this won't let them modify, alas
713}
714
715sub eval {
716
717    # 'my' would make it visible from user code
718    #    but so does local! --tchrist
719    # Remember: this localizes @DB::res, not @main::res.
720    local @res;
721    {
722
723        # Try to keep the user code from messing  with us. Save these so that
724        # even if the eval'ed code changes them, we can put them back again.
725        # Needed because the user could refer directly to the debugger's
726        # package globals (and any 'my' variables in this containing scope)
727        # inside the eval(), and we want to try to stay safe.
728        local $otrace  = $trace;
729        local $osingle = $single;
730        local $od      = $^D;
731
732        # Untaint the incoming eval() argument.
733        { ($evalarg) = $evalarg =~ /(.*)/s; }
734
735        # $usercontext built in DB::DB near the comment
736        # "set up the context for DB::eval ..."
737        # Evaluate and save any results.
738        @res = eval "$usercontext $evalarg;\n";  # '\n' for nice recursive debug
739
740        # Restore those old values.
741        $trace  = $otrace;
742        $single = $osingle;
743        $^D     = $od;
744    }
745
746    # Save the current value of $@, and preserve it in the debugger's copy
747    # of the saved precious globals.
748    my $at = $@;
749
750    # Since we're only saving $@, we only have to localize the array element
751    # that it will be stored in.
752    local $saved[0];    # Preserve the old value of $@
753    eval { &DB::save };
754
755    # Now see whether we need to report an error back to the user.
756    if ($at) {
757        local $\ = '';
758        print $OUT $at;
759    }
760
761    # Display as required by the caller. $onetimeDump and $onetimedumpDepth
762    # are package globals.
763    elsif ($onetimeDump) {
764        if ( $onetimeDump eq 'dump' ) {
765            local $option{dumpDepth} = $onetimedumpDepth
766              if defined $onetimedumpDepth;
767            dumpit( $OUT, \@res );
768        }
769        elsif ( $onetimeDump eq 'methods' ) {
770            methods( $res[0] );
771        }
772    } ## end elsif ($onetimeDump)
773    @res;
774} ## end sub eval
775
776############################################## End lexical danger zone
777
778# After this point it is safe to introduce lexicals.
779# The code being debugged will be executing in its own context, and
780# can't see the inside of the debugger.
781#
782# However, one should not overdo it: leave as much control from outside as
783# possible. If you make something a lexical, it's not going to be addressable
784# from outside the debugger even if you know its name.
785
786# This file is automatically included if you do perl -d.
787# It's probably not useful to include this yourself.
788#
789# Before venturing further into these twisty passages, it is
790# wise to read the perldebguts man page or risk the ire of dragons.
791#
792# (It should be noted that perldebguts will tell you a lot about
793# the underlying mechanics of how the debugger interfaces into the
794# Perl interpreter, but not a lot about the debugger itself. The new
795# comments in this code try to address this problem.)
796
797# Note that no subroutine call is possible until &DB::sub is defined
798# (for subroutines defined outside of the package DB). In fact the same is
799# true if $deep is not defined.
800
801# Enhanced by ilya@math.ohio-state.edu (Ilya Zakharevich)
802
803# modified Perl debugger, to be run from Emacs in perldb-mode
804# Ray Lischner (uunet!mntgfx!lisch) as of 5 Nov 1990
805# Johan Vromans -- upgrade to 4.0 pl 10
806# Ilya Zakharevich -- patches after 5.001 (and some before ;-)
807########################################################################
808
809=head1 DEBUGGER INITIALIZATION
810
811The debugger starts up in phases.
812
813=head2 BASIC SETUP
814
815First, it initializes the environment it wants to run in: turning off
816warnings during its own compilation, defining variables which it will need
817to avoid warnings later, setting itself up to not exit when the program
818terminates, and defaulting to printing return values for the C<r> command.
819
820=cut
821
822# Needed for the statement after exec():
823#
824# This BEGIN block is simply used to switch off warnings during debugger
825# compilation. Probably it would be better practice to fix the warnings,
826# but this is how it's done at the moment.
827
828BEGIN {
829    $ini_warn = $^W;
830    $^W       = 0;
831}    # Switch compilation warnings off until another BEGIN.
832
833local ($^W) = 0;    # Switch run-time warnings off during init.
834
835=head2 THREADS SUPPORT
836
837If we are running under a threaded Perl, we require threads and threads::shared
838if the environment variable C<PERL5DB_THREADED> is set, to enable proper
839threaded debugger control.  C<-dt> can also be used to set this.
840
841Each new thread will be announced and the debugger prompt will always inform
842you of each new thread created.  It will also indicate the thread id in which
843we are currently running within the prompt like this:
844
845    [tid] DB<$i>
846
847Where C<[tid]> is an integer thread id and C<$i> is the familiar debugger
848command prompt.  The prompt will show: C<[0]> when running under threads, but
849not actually in a thread.  C<[tid]> is consistent with C<gdb> usage.
850
851While running under threads, when you set or delete a breakpoint (etc.), this
852will apply to all threads, not just the currently running one.  When you are
853in a currently executing thread, you will stay there until it completes.  With
854the current implementation it is not currently possible to hop from one thread
855to another.
856
857The C<e> and C<E> commands are currently fairly minimal - see C<h e> and C<h E>.
858
859Note that threading support was built into the debugger as of Perl version
860C<5.8.6> and debugger version C<1.2.8>.
861
862=cut
863
864BEGIN {
865    # ensure we can share our non-threaded variables or no-op
866    if ($ENV{PERL5DB_THREADED}) {
867        require threads;
868        require threads::shared;
869        import threads::shared qw(share);
870        $DBGR;
871        share(\$DBGR);
872        lock($DBGR);
873        print "Threads support enabled\n";
874    } else {
875        *lock = sub(*) {};
876        *share = sub(\[$@%]) {};
877    }
878}
879
880# These variables control the execution of 'dumpvar.pl'.
881{
882    package dumpvar;
883    use vars qw(
884    $hashDepth
885    $arrayDepth
886    $dumpDBFiles
887    $dumpPackages
888    $quoteHighBit
889    $printUndef
890    $globPrint
891    $usageOnly
892    );
893}
894
895# used to control die() reporting in diesignal()
896{
897    package Carp;
898    use vars qw($CarpLevel);
899}
900
901# without threads, $filename is not defined until DB::DB is called
902share($main::{'_<'.$filename}) if defined $filename;
903
904# Command-line + PERLLIB:
905# Save the contents of @INC before they are modified elsewhere.
906@ini_INC = @INC;
907
908# This was an attempt to clear out the previous values of various
909# trapped errors. Apparently it didn't help. XXX More info needed!
910# $prevwarn = $prevdie = $prevbus = $prevsegv = ''; # Does not help?!
911
912# We set these variables to safe values. We don't want to blindly turn
913# off warnings, because other packages may still want them.
914$trace = $signal = $single = 0;    # Uninitialized warning suppression
915                                   # (local $^W cannot help - other packages!).
916
917# Default to not exiting when program finishes; print the return
918# value when the 'r' command is used to return from a subroutine.
919$inhibit_exit = $option{PrintRet} = 1;
920
921use vars qw($trace_to_depth);
922
923# Default to 1E9 so it won't be limited to a certain recursion depth.
924$trace_to_depth = 1E9;
925
926=head1 OPTION PROCESSING
927
928The debugger's options are actually spread out over the debugger itself and
929C<dumpvar.pl>; some of these are variables to be set, while others are
930subs to be called with a value. To try to make this a little easier to
931manage, the debugger uses a few data structures to define what options
932are legal and how they are to be processed.
933
934First, the C<@options> array defines the I<names> of all the options that
935are to be accepted.
936
937=cut
938
939@options = qw(
940  CommandSet   HistFile      HistSize
941  hashDepth    arrayDepth    dumpDepth
942  DumpDBFiles  DumpPackages  DumpReused
943  compactDump  veryCompact   quote
944  HighBit      undefPrint    globPrint
945  PrintRet     UsageOnly     frame
946  AutoTrace    TTY           noTTY
947  ReadLine     NonStop       LineInfo
948  maxTraceLen  recallCommand ShellBang
949  pager        tkRunning     ornaments
950  signalLevel  warnLevel     dieLevel
951  inhibit_exit ImmediateStop bareStringify
952  CreateTTY    RemotePort    windowSize
953  DollarCaretP
954);
955
956@RememberOnROptions = qw(DollarCaretP);
957
958=pod
959
960Second, C<optionVars> lists the variables that each option uses to save its
961state.
962
963=cut
964
965use vars qw(%optionVars);
966
967%optionVars = (
968    hashDepth     => \$dumpvar::hashDepth,
969    arrayDepth    => \$dumpvar::arrayDepth,
970    CommandSet    => \$CommandSet,
971    DumpDBFiles   => \$dumpvar::dumpDBFiles,
972    DumpPackages  => \$dumpvar::dumpPackages,
973    DumpReused    => \$dumpvar::dumpReused,
974    HighBit       => \$dumpvar::quoteHighBit,
975    undefPrint    => \$dumpvar::printUndef,
976    globPrint     => \$dumpvar::globPrint,
977    UsageOnly     => \$dumpvar::usageOnly,
978    CreateTTY     => \$CreateTTY,
979    bareStringify => \$dumpvar::bareStringify,
980    frame         => \$frame,
981    AutoTrace     => \$trace,
982    inhibit_exit  => \$inhibit_exit,
983    maxTraceLen   => \$maxtrace,
984    ImmediateStop => \$ImmediateStop,
985    RemotePort    => \$remoteport,
986    windowSize    => \$window,
987    HistFile      => \$histfile,
988    HistSize      => \$histsize,
989);
990
991=pod
992
993Third, C<%optionAction> defines the subroutine to be called to process each
994option.
995
996=cut
997
998use vars qw(%optionAction);
999
1000%optionAction = (
1001    compactDump   => \&dumpvar::compactDump,
1002    veryCompact   => \&dumpvar::veryCompact,
1003    quote         => \&dumpvar::quote,
1004    TTY           => \&TTY,
1005    noTTY         => \&noTTY,
1006    ReadLine      => \&ReadLine,
1007    NonStop       => \&NonStop,
1008    LineInfo      => \&LineInfo,
1009    recallCommand => \&recallCommand,
1010    ShellBang     => \&shellBang,
1011    pager         => \&pager,
1012    signalLevel   => \&signalLevel,
1013    warnLevel     => \&warnLevel,
1014    dieLevel      => \&dieLevel,
1015    tkRunning     => \&tkRunning,
1016    ornaments     => \&ornaments,
1017    RemotePort    => \&RemotePort,
1018    DollarCaretP  => \&DollarCaretP,
1019);
1020
1021=pod
1022
1023Last, the C<%optionRequire> notes modules that must be C<require>d if an
1024option is used.
1025
1026=cut
1027
1028# Note that this list is not complete: several options not listed here
1029# actually require that dumpvar.pl be loaded for them to work, but are
1030# not in the table. A subsequent patch will correct this problem; for
1031# the moment, we're just recommenting, and we are NOT going to change
1032# function.
1033use vars qw(%optionRequire);
1034
1035%optionRequire = (
1036    compactDump => 'dumpvar.pl',
1037    veryCompact => 'dumpvar.pl',
1038    quote       => 'dumpvar.pl',
1039);
1040
1041=pod
1042
1043There are a number of initialization-related variables which can be set
1044by putting code to set them in a BEGIN block in the C<PERL5DB> environment
1045variable. These are:
1046
1047=over 4
1048
1049=item C<$rl> - readline control XXX needs more explanation
1050
1051=item C<$warnLevel> - whether or not debugger takes over warning handling
1052
1053=item C<$dieLevel> - whether or not debugger takes over die handling
1054
1055=item C<$signalLevel> - whether or not debugger takes over signal handling
1056
1057=item C<$pre> - preprompt actions (array reference)
1058
1059=item C<$post> - postprompt actions (array reference)
1060
1061=item C<$pretype>
1062
1063=item C<$CreateTTY> - whether or not to create a new TTY for this debugger
1064
1065=item C<$CommandSet> - which command set to use (defaults to new, documented set)
1066
1067=back
1068
1069=cut
1070
1071# These guys may be defined in $ENV{PERL5DB} :
1072$rl          = 1     unless defined $rl;
1073$warnLevel   = 1     unless defined $warnLevel;
1074$dieLevel    = 1     unless defined $dieLevel;
1075$signalLevel = 1     unless defined $signalLevel;
1076$pre         = []    unless defined $pre;
1077$post        = []    unless defined $post;
1078$pretype     = []    unless defined $pretype;
1079$CreateTTY   = 3     unless defined $CreateTTY;
1080$CommandSet  = '580' unless defined $CommandSet;
1081
1082share($rl);
1083share($warnLevel);
1084share($dieLevel);
1085share($signalLevel);
1086share($pre);
1087share($post);
1088share($pretype);
1089share($rl);
1090share($CreateTTY);
1091share($CommandSet);
1092
1093=pod
1094
1095The default C<die>, C<warn>, and C<signal> handlers are set up.
1096
1097=cut
1098
1099warnLevel($warnLevel);
1100dieLevel($dieLevel);
1101signalLevel($signalLevel);
1102
1103=pod
1104
1105The pager to be used is needed next. We try to get it from the
1106environment first.  If it's not defined there, we try to find it in
1107the Perl C<Config.pm>.  If it's not there, we default to C<more>. We
1108then call the C<pager()> function to save the pager name.
1109
1110=cut
1111
1112# This routine makes sure $pager is set up so that '|' can use it.
1113pager(
1114
1115    # If PAGER is defined in the environment, use it.
1116    defined $ENV{PAGER}
1117    ? $ENV{PAGER}
1118
1119      # If not, see if Config.pm defines it.
1120    : eval { require Config }
1121      && defined $Config::Config{pager}
1122    ? $Config::Config{pager}
1123
1124      # If not, fall back to 'more'.
1125    : 'more'
1126  )
1127  unless defined $pager;
1128
1129=pod
1130
1131We set up the command to be used to access the man pages, the command
1132recall character (C<!> unless otherwise defined) and the shell escape
1133character (C<!> unless otherwise defined). Yes, these do conflict, and
1134neither works in the debugger at the moment.
1135
1136=cut
1137
1138setman();
1139
1140# Set up defaults for command recall and shell escape (note:
1141# these currently don't work in linemode debugging).
1142recallCommand("!") unless defined $prc;
1143shellBang("!")     unless defined $psh;
1144
1145=pod
1146
1147We then set up the gigantic string containing the debugger help.
1148We also set the limit on the number of arguments we'll display during a
1149trace.
1150
1151=cut
1152
1153sethelp();
1154
1155# If we didn't get a default for the length of eval/stack trace args,
1156# set it here.
1157$maxtrace = 400 unless defined $maxtrace;
1158
1159=head2 SETTING UP THE DEBUGGER GREETING
1160
1161The debugger I<greeting> helps to inform the user how many debuggers are
1162running, and whether the current debugger is the primary or a child.
1163
1164If we are the primary, we just hang onto our pid so we'll have it when
1165or if we start a child debugger. If we are a child, we'll set things up
1166so we'll have a unique greeting and so the parent will give us our own
1167TTY later.
1168
1169We save the current contents of the C<PERLDB_PIDS> environment variable
1170because we mess around with it. We'll also need to hang onto it because
1171we'll need it if we restart.
1172
1173Child debuggers make a label out of the current PID structure recorded in
1174PERLDB_PIDS plus the new PID. They also mark themselves as not having a TTY
1175yet so the parent will give them one later via C<resetterm()>.
1176
1177=cut
1178
1179# Save the current contents of the environment; we're about to
1180# much with it. We'll need this if we have to restart.
1181use vars qw($ini_pids);
1182$ini_pids = $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS};
1183
1184use vars qw ($pids $term_pid);
1185
1186if ( defined $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS} ) {
1187
1188    # We're a child. Make us a label out of the current PID structure
1189    # recorded in PERLDB_PIDS plus our (new) PID. Mark us as not having
1190    # a term yet so the parent will give us one later via resetterm().
1191
1192    my $env_pids = $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS};
1193    $pids = "[$env_pids]";
1194
1195    # Unless we are on OpenVMS, all programs under the DCL shell run under
1196    # the same PID.
1197
1198    if (($^O eq 'VMS') && ($env_pids =~ /\b$$\b/)) {
1199        $term_pid         = $$;
1200    }
1201    else {
1202        $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS} .= "->$$";
1203        $term_pid = -1;
1204    }
1205
1206} ## end if (defined $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS...
1207else {
1208
1209    # We're the parent PID. Initialize PERLDB_PID in case we end up with a
1210    # child debugger, and mark us as the parent, so we'll know to set up
1211    # more TTY's is we have to.
1212    $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS} = "$$";
1213    $pids             = "[pid=$$]";
1214    $term_pid         = $$;
1215}
1216
1217use vars qw($pidprompt);
1218$pidprompt = '';
1219
1220# Sets up $emacs as a synonym for $slave_editor.
1221our ($slave_editor);
1222*emacs = $slave_editor if $slave_editor;    # May be used in afterinit()...
1223
1224=head2 READING THE RC FILE
1225
1226The debugger will read a file of initialization options if supplied. If
1227running interactively, this is C<.perldb>; if not, it's C<perldb.ini>.
1228
1229=cut
1230
1231# As noted, this test really doesn't check accurately that the debugger
1232# is running at a terminal or not.
1233
1234use vars qw($rcfile);
1235{
1236    my $dev_tty = (($^O eq 'VMS') ? 'TT:' : '/dev/tty');
1237    # this is the wrong metric!
1238    $rcfile = ((-e $dev_tty) ? ".perldb" : "perldb.ini");
1239}
1240
1241=pod
1242
1243The debugger does a safety test of the file to be read. It must be owned
1244either by the current user or root, and must only be writable by the owner.
1245
1246=cut
1247
1248# This wraps a safety test around "do" to read and evaluate the init file.
1249#
1250# This isn't really safe, because there's a race
1251# between checking and opening.  The solution is to
1252# open and fstat the handle, but then you have to read and
1253# eval the contents.  But then the silly thing gets
1254# your lexical scope, which is unfortunate at best.
1255sub safe_do {
1256    my $file = shift;
1257
1258    # Just exactly what part of the word "CORE::" don't you understand?
1259    local $SIG{__WARN__};
1260    local $SIG{__DIE__};
1261
1262    unless ( is_safe_file($file) ) {
1263        CORE::warn <<EO_GRIPE;
1264perldb: Must not source insecure rcfile $file.
1265        You or the superuser must be the owner, and it must not
1266        be writable by anyone but its owner.
1267EO_GRIPE
1268        return;
1269    } ## end unless (is_safe_file($file...
1270
1271    do $file;
1272    CORE::warn("perldb: couldn't parse $file: $@") if $@;
1273} ## end sub safe_do
1274
1275# This is the safety test itself.
1276#
1277# Verifies that owner is either real user or superuser and that no
1278# one but owner may write to it.  This function is of limited use
1279# when called on a path instead of upon a handle, because there are
1280# no guarantees that filename (by dirent) whose file (by ino) is
1281# eventually accessed is the same as the one tested.
1282# Assumes that the file's existence is not in doubt.
1283sub is_safe_file {
1284    my $path = shift;
1285    stat($path) || return;    # mysteriously vaporized
1286    my ( $dev, $ino, $mode, $nlink, $uid, $gid ) = stat(_);
1287
1288    return 0 if $uid != 0 && $uid != $<;
1289    return 0 if $mode & 022;
1290    return 1;
1291} ## end sub is_safe_file
1292
1293# If the rcfile (whichever one we decided was the right one to read)
1294# exists, we safely do it.
1295if ( -f $rcfile ) {
1296    safe_do("./$rcfile");
1297}
1298
1299# If there isn't one here, try the user's home directory.
1300elsif ( defined $ENV{HOME} && -f "$ENV{HOME}/$rcfile" ) {
1301    safe_do("$ENV{HOME}/$rcfile");
1302}
1303
1304# Else try the login directory.
1305elsif ( defined $ENV{LOGDIR} && -f "$ENV{LOGDIR}/$rcfile" ) {
1306    safe_do("$ENV{LOGDIR}/$rcfile");
1307}
1308
1309# If the PERLDB_OPTS variable has options in it, parse those out next.
1310if ( defined $ENV{PERLDB_OPTS} ) {
1311    parse_options( $ENV{PERLDB_OPTS} );
1312}
1313
1314=pod
1315
1316The last thing we do during initialization is determine which subroutine is
1317to be used to obtain a new terminal when a new debugger is started. Right now,
1318the debugger only handles TCP sockets, X11, OS/2, amd Mac OS X
1319(darwin).
1320
1321=cut
1322
1323# Set up the get_fork_TTY subroutine to be aliased to the proper routine.
1324# Works if you're running an xterm or xterm-like window, or you're on
1325# OS/2, or on Mac OS X. This may need some expansion.
1326
1327if (not defined &get_fork_TTY)       # only if no routine exists
1328{
1329    if ( defined $remoteport ) {
1330                                                 # Expect an inetd-like server
1331        *get_fork_TTY = \&socket_get_fork_TTY;   # to listen to us
1332    }
1333    elsif (defined $ENV{TERM}                    # If we know what kind
1334                                                 # of terminal this is,
1335        and $ENV{TERM} eq 'xterm'                # and it's an xterm,
1336        and defined $ENV{DISPLAY}                # and what display it's on,
1337      )
1338    {
1339        *get_fork_TTY = \&xterm_get_fork_TTY;    # use the xterm version
1340    }
1341    elsif ( $ENV{TMUX} ) {
1342        *get_fork_TTY = \&tmux_get_fork_TTY;
1343    }
1344    elsif ( $^O eq 'os2' ) {                     # If this is OS/2,
1345        *get_fork_TTY = \&os2_get_fork_TTY;      # use the OS/2 version
1346    }
1347    elsif ( $^O eq 'darwin'                      # If this is Mac OS X
1348            and defined $ENV{TERM_PROGRAM}       # and we're running inside
1349            and $ENV{TERM_PROGRAM}
1350                eq 'Apple_Terminal'              # Terminal.app
1351            )
1352    {
1353        *get_fork_TTY = \&macosx_get_fork_TTY;   # use the Mac OS X version
1354    }
1355} ## end if (not defined &get_fork_TTY...
1356
1357# untaint $^O, which may have been tainted by the last statement.
1358# see bug [perl #24674]
1359$^O =~ m/^(.*)\z/;
1360$^O = $1;
1361
1362# Here begin the unreadable code.  It needs fixing.
1363
1364=head2 RESTART PROCESSING
1365
1366This section handles the restart command. When the C<R> command is invoked, it
1367tries to capture all of the state it can into environment variables, and
1368then sets C<PERLDB_RESTART>. When we start executing again, we check to see
1369if C<PERLDB_RESTART> is there; if so, we reload all the information that
1370the R command stuffed into the environment variables.
1371
1372  PERLDB_RESTART   - flag only, contains no restart data itself.
1373  PERLDB_HIST      - command history, if it's available
1374  PERLDB_ON_LOAD   - breakpoints set by the rc file
1375  PERLDB_POSTPONE  - subs that have been loaded/not executed,
1376                     and have actions
1377  PERLDB_VISITED   - files that had breakpoints
1378  PERLDB_FILE_...  - breakpoints for a file
1379  PERLDB_OPT       - active options
1380  PERLDB_INC       - the original @INC
1381  PERLDB_PRETYPE   - preprompt debugger actions
1382  PERLDB_PRE       - preprompt Perl code
1383  PERLDB_POST      - post-prompt Perl code
1384  PERLDB_TYPEAHEAD - typeahead captured by readline()
1385
1386We chug through all these variables and plug the values saved in them
1387back into the appropriate spots in the debugger.
1388
1389=cut
1390
1391use vars qw(%postponed_file @typeahead);
1392
1393our (@hist, @truehist);
1394
1395sub _restore_shared_globals_after_restart
1396{
1397    @hist          = get_list('PERLDB_HIST');
1398    %break_on_load = get_list("PERLDB_ON_LOAD");
1399    %postponed     = get_list("PERLDB_POSTPONE");
1400
1401    share(@hist);
1402    share(@truehist);
1403    share(%break_on_load);
1404    share(%postponed);
1405}
1406
1407sub _restore_breakpoints_and_actions {
1408
1409    my @had_breakpoints = get_list("PERLDB_VISITED");
1410
1411    for my $file_idx ( 0 .. $#had_breakpoints ) {
1412        my $filename = $had_breakpoints[$file_idx];
1413        my %pf = get_list("PERLDB_FILE_$file_idx");
1414        $postponed_file{ $filename } = \%pf if %pf;
1415        my @lines = sort {$a <=> $b} keys(%pf);
1416        my @enabled_statuses = get_list("PERLDB_FILE_ENABLED_$file_idx");
1417        for my $line_idx (0 .. $#lines) {
1418            _set_breakpoint_enabled_status(
1419                $filename,
1420                $lines[$line_idx],
1421                ($enabled_statuses[$line_idx] ? 1 : ''),
1422            );
1423        }
1424    }
1425
1426    return;
1427}
1428
1429sub _restore_options_after_restart
1430{
1431    my %options_map = get_list("PERLDB_OPT");
1432
1433    while ( my ( $opt, $val ) = each %options_map ) {
1434        $val =~ s/[\\\']/\\$1/g;
1435        parse_options("$opt'$val'");
1436    }
1437
1438    return;
1439}
1440
1441sub _restore_globals_after_restart
1442{
1443    # restore original @INC
1444    @INC     = get_list("PERLDB_INC");
1445    @ini_INC = @INC;
1446
1447    # return pre/postprompt actions and typeahead buffer
1448    $pretype   = [ get_list("PERLDB_PRETYPE") ];
1449    $pre       = [ get_list("PERLDB_PRE") ];
1450    $post      = [ get_list("PERLDB_POST") ];
1451    @typeahead = get_list( "PERLDB_TYPEAHEAD", @typeahead );
1452
1453    return;
1454}
1455
1456
1457if ( exists $ENV{PERLDB_RESTART} ) {
1458
1459    # We're restarting, so we don't need the flag that says to restart anymore.
1460    delete $ENV{PERLDB_RESTART};
1461
1462    # $restart = 1;
1463    _restore_shared_globals_after_restart();
1464
1465    _restore_breakpoints_and_actions();
1466
1467    # restore options
1468    _restore_options_after_restart();
1469
1470    _restore_globals_after_restart();
1471} ## end if (exists $ENV{PERLDB_RESTART...
1472
1473=head2 SETTING UP THE TERMINAL
1474
1475Now, we'll decide how the debugger is going to interact with the user.
1476If there's no TTY, we set the debugger to run non-stop; there's not going
1477to be anyone there to enter commands.
1478
1479=cut
1480
1481use vars qw($notty $console $tty $LINEINFO);
1482use vars qw($lineinfo $doccmd);
1483
1484our ($runnonstop);
1485
1486# Local autoflush to avoid rt#116769,
1487# as calling IO::File methods causes an unresolvable loop
1488# that results in debugger failure.
1489sub _autoflush {
1490    my $o = select($_[0]);
1491    $|++;
1492    select($o);
1493}
1494
1495if ($notty) {
1496    $runnonstop = 1;
1497    share($runnonstop);
1498}
1499
1500=pod
1501
1502If there is a TTY, we have to determine who it belongs to before we can
1503proceed. If this is a slave editor or graphical debugger (denoted by
1504the first command-line switch being '-emacs'), we shift this off and
1505set C<$rl> to 0 (XXX ostensibly to do straight reads).
1506
1507=cut
1508
1509else {
1510
1511    # Is Perl being run from a slave editor or graphical debugger?
1512    # If so, don't use readline, and set $slave_editor = 1.
1513    if ($slave_editor = ( @main::ARGV && ( $main::ARGV[0] eq '-emacs' ) )) {
1514        $rl = 0;
1515        shift(@main::ARGV);
1516    }
1517
1518    #require Term::ReadLine;
1519
1520=pod
1521
1522We then determine what the console should be on various systems:
1523
1524=over 4
1525
1526=item * Cygwin - We use C<stdin> instead of a separate device.
1527
1528=cut
1529
1530    if ( $^O eq 'cygwin' ) {
1531
1532        # /dev/tty is binary. use stdin for textmode
1533        undef $console;
1534    }
1535
1536=item * Windows or MSDOS - use C<con>.
1537
1538=cut
1539
1540    elsif ( $^O eq 'dos' or -e "con" or $^O eq 'MSWin32' ) {
1541        $console = "con";
1542    }
1543
1544=item * AmigaOS - use C<CONSOLE:>.
1545
1546=cut
1547
1548    elsif ( $^O eq 'amigaos' ) {
1549        $console = "CONSOLE:";
1550    }
1551
1552=item * VMS - use C<sys$command>.
1553
1554=cut
1555
1556    elsif ($^O eq 'VMS') {
1557        $console = 'sys$command';
1558    }
1559
1560# Keep this penultimate, on the grounds that it satisfies a wide variety of
1561# Unix-like systems that would otherwise need to be identified individually.
1562
1563=item * Unix - use F</dev/tty>.
1564
1565=cut
1566
1567    elsif ( -e "/dev/tty" ) {
1568        $console = "/dev/tty";
1569    }
1570
1571# Keep this last.
1572
1573    else {
1574        _db_warn("Can't figure out your console, using stdin");
1575        undef $console;
1576    }
1577
1578=pod
1579
1580=back
1581
1582Several other systems don't use a specific console. We C<undef $console>
1583for those (Windows using a slave editor/graphical debugger, NetWare, OS/2
1584with a slave editor).
1585
1586=cut
1587
1588    if ( ( $^O eq 'MSWin32' ) and ( $slave_editor or defined $ENV{EMACS} ) ) {
1589
1590        # /dev/tty is binary. use stdin for textmode
1591        $console = undef;
1592    }
1593
1594    if ( $^O eq 'NetWare' ) {
1595
1596        # /dev/tty is binary. use stdin for textmode
1597        $console = undef;
1598    }
1599
1600    # In OS/2, we need to use STDIN to get textmode too, even though
1601    # it pretty much looks like Unix otherwise.
1602    if ( defined $ENV{OS2_SHELL} and ( $slave_editor or $ENV{WINDOWID} ) )
1603    {    # In OS/2
1604        $console = undef;
1605    }
1606
1607=pod
1608
1609If there is a TTY hanging around from a parent, we use that as the console.
1610
1611=cut
1612
1613    $console = $tty if defined $tty;
1614
1615=head2 SOCKET HANDLING
1616
1617The debugger is capable of opening a socket and carrying out a debugging
1618session over the socket.
1619
1620If C<RemotePort> was defined in the options, the debugger assumes that it
1621should try to start a debugging session on that port. It builds the socket
1622and then tries to connect the input and output filehandles to it.
1623
1624=cut
1625
1626    # Handle socket stuff.
1627
1628    if ( defined $remoteport ) {
1629
1630        # If RemotePort was defined in the options, connect input and output
1631        # to the socket.
1632        $IN = $OUT = connect_remoteport();
1633    } ## end if (defined $remoteport)
1634
1635=pod
1636
1637If no C<RemotePort> was defined, and we want to create a TTY on startup,
1638this is probably a situation where multiple debuggers are running (for example,
1639a backticked command that starts up another debugger). We create a new IN and
1640OUT filehandle, and do the necessary mojo to create a new TTY if we know how
1641and if we can.
1642
1643=cut
1644
1645    # Non-socket.
1646    else {
1647
1648        # Two debuggers running (probably a system or a backtick that invokes
1649        # the debugger itself under the running one). create a new IN and OUT
1650        # filehandle, and do the necessary mojo to create a new tty if we
1651        # know how, and we can.
1652        create_IN_OUT(4) if $CreateTTY & 4;
1653        if ($console) {
1654
1655            # If we have a console, check to see if there are separate ins and
1656            # outs to open. (They are assumed identical if not.)
1657
1658            my ( $i, $o ) = split /,/, $console;
1659            $o = $i unless defined $o;
1660
1661            # read/write on in, or just read, or read on STDIN.
1662                 open( IN, '+<', $i )
1663              || open( IN, '<',  $i )
1664              || open( IN, "<&STDIN" );
1665
1666            # read/write/create/clobber out, or write/create/clobber out,
1667            # or merge with STDERR, or merge with STDOUT.
1668                 open( OUT, '+>', $o )
1669              || open( OUT, '>',  $o )
1670              || open( OUT, ">&STDERR" )
1671              || open( OUT, ">&STDOUT" );    # so we don't dongle stdout
1672
1673        } ## end if ($console)
1674        elsif ( not defined $console ) {
1675
1676            # No console. Open STDIN.
1677            open( IN, "<&STDIN" );
1678
1679            # merge with STDERR, or with STDOUT.
1680            open( OUT,      ">&STDERR" )
1681              || open( OUT, ">&STDOUT" );    # so we don't dongle stdout
1682            $console = 'STDIN/OUT';
1683        } ## end elsif (not defined $console)
1684
1685        # Keep copies of the filehandles so that when the pager runs, it
1686        # can close standard input without clobbering ours.
1687        if ($console or (not defined($console))) {
1688            $IN = \*IN;
1689            $OUT = \*OUT;
1690        }
1691    } ## end elsif (from if(defined $remoteport))
1692
1693    # Unbuffer DB::OUT. We need to see responses right away.
1694    _autoflush($OUT);
1695
1696    # Line info goes to debugger output unless pointed elsewhere.
1697    # Pointing elsewhere makes it possible for slave editors to
1698    # keep track of file and position. We have both a filehandle
1699    # and a I/O description to keep track of.
1700    $LINEINFO = $OUT     unless defined $LINEINFO;
1701    $lineinfo = $console unless defined $lineinfo;
1702    # share($LINEINFO); # <- unable to share globs
1703    share($lineinfo);   #
1704
1705=pod
1706
1707To finish initialization, we show the debugger greeting,
1708and then call the C<afterinit()> subroutine if there is one.
1709
1710=cut
1711
1712    # Show the debugger greeting.
1713    $header =~ s/.Header: ([^,]+),v(\s+\S+\s+\S+).*$/$1$2/;
1714    unless ($runnonstop) {
1715        local $\ = '';
1716        local $, = '';
1717        if ( $term_pid eq '-1' ) {
1718            print $OUT "\nDaughter DB session started...\n";
1719        }
1720        else {
1721            print $OUT "\nLoading DB routines from $header\n";
1722            print $OUT (
1723                "Editor support ",
1724                $slave_editor ? "enabled" : "available", ".\n"
1725            );
1726            print $OUT
1727"\nEnter h or 'h h' for help, or '$doccmd perldebug' for more help.\n\n";
1728        } ## end else [ if ($term_pid eq '-1')
1729    } ## end unless ($runnonstop)
1730} ## end else [ if ($notty)
1731
1732# XXX This looks like a bug to me.
1733# Why copy to @ARGS and then futz with @args?
1734@ARGS = @ARGV;
1735# for (@args) {
1736    # Make sure backslashes before single quotes are stripped out, and
1737    # keep args unless they are numeric (XXX why?)
1738    # s/\'/\\\'/g;                      # removed while not justified understandably
1739    # s/(.*)/'$1'/ unless /^-?[\d.]+$/; # ditto
1740# }
1741
1742# If there was an afterinit() sub defined, call it. It will get
1743# executed in our scope, so it can fiddle with debugger globals.
1744if ( defined &afterinit ) {    # May be defined in $rcfile
1745    afterinit();
1746}
1747
1748# Inform us about "Stack dump during die enabled ..." in dieLevel().
1749use vars qw($I_m_init);
1750
1751$I_m_init = 1;
1752
1753############################################################ Subroutines
1754
1755=head1 SUBROUTINES
1756
1757=head2 DB
1758
1759This gigantic subroutine is the heart of the debugger. Called before every
1760statement, its job is to determine if a breakpoint has been reached, and
1761stop if so; read commands from the user, parse them, and execute
1762them, and then send execution off to the next statement.
1763
1764Note that the order in which the commands are processed is very important;
1765some commands earlier in the loop will actually alter the C<$cmd> variable
1766to create other commands to be executed later. This is all highly I<optimized>
1767but can be confusing. Check the comments for each C<$cmd ... && do {}> to
1768see what's happening in any given command.
1769
1770=cut
1771
1772# $cmd cannot be an our() variable unfortunately (possible perl bug?).
1773
1774use vars qw(
1775    $action
1776    $cmd
1777    $file
1778    $filename_ini
1779    $finished
1780    %had_breakpoints
1781    $level
1782    $max
1783    $package
1784    $try
1785);
1786
1787our (
1788    %alias,
1789    $doret,
1790    $end,
1791    $fall_off_end,
1792    $incr,
1793    $laststep,
1794    $rc,
1795    $sh,
1796    $stack_depth,
1797    @stack,
1798    @to_watch,
1799    @old_watch,
1800);
1801
1802sub _DB__determine_if_we_should_break
1803{
1804    # if we have something here, see if we should break.
1805    # $stop is lexical and local to this block - $action on the other hand
1806    # is global.
1807    my $stop;
1808
1809    if ( $dbline{$line}
1810        && _is_breakpoint_enabled($filename, $line)
1811        && (( $stop, $action ) = split( /\0/, $dbline{$line} ) ) )
1812    {
1813
1814        # Stop if the stop criterion says to just stop.
1815        if ( $stop eq '1' ) {
1816            $signal |= 1;
1817        }
1818
1819        # It's a conditional stop; eval it in the user's context and
1820        # see if we should stop. If so, remove the one-time sigil.
1821        elsif ($stop) {
1822            $evalarg = "\$DB::signal |= 1 if do {$stop}";
1823            # The &-call is here to ascertain the mutability of @_.
1824            &DB::eval;
1825            # If the breakpoint is temporary, then delete its enabled status.
1826            if ($dbline{$line} =~ s/;9($|\0)/$1/) {
1827                _cancel_breakpoint_temp_enabled_status($filename, $line);
1828            }
1829        }
1830    } ## end if ($dbline{$line} && ...
1831}
1832
1833sub _DB__is_finished {
1834    if ($finished and $level <= 1) {
1835        end_report();
1836        return 1;
1837    }
1838    else {
1839        return;
1840    }
1841}
1842
1843sub _DB__read_next_cmd
1844{
1845    my ($tid) = @_;
1846
1847    # We have a terminal, or can get one ...
1848    if (!$term) {
1849        setterm();
1850    }
1851
1852    # ... and it belongs to this PID or we get one for this PID ...
1853    if ($term_pid != $$) {
1854        resetterm(1);
1855    }
1856
1857    # ... and we got a line of command input ...
1858    $cmd = DB::readline(
1859        "$pidprompt $tid DB"
1860        . ( '<' x $level )
1861        . ( $#hist + 1 )
1862        . ( '>' x $level ) . " "
1863    );
1864
1865    return defined($cmd);
1866}
1867
1868sub _DB__trim_command_and_return_first_component {
1869    my ($obj) = @_;
1870
1871    $cmd =~ s/\A\s+//s;    # trim annoying leading whitespace
1872    $cmd =~ s/\s+\z//s;    # trim annoying trailing whitespace
1873
1874    # A single-character debugger command can be immediately followed by its
1875    # argument if they aren't both alphanumeric; otherwise require space
1876    # between commands and arguments:
1877    my ($verb, $args) = $cmd =~ m{\A(.\b|\S*)\s*(.*)}s;
1878
1879    $obj->cmd_verb($verb);
1880    $obj->cmd_args($args);
1881
1882    return;
1883}
1884
1885sub _DB__handle_f_command {
1886    my ($obj) = @_;
1887
1888    if ($file = $obj->cmd_args) {
1889        # help for no arguments (old-style was return from sub).
1890        if ( !$file ) {
1891            print $OUT
1892            "The old f command is now the r command.\n";    # hint
1893            print $OUT "The new f command switches filenames.\n";
1894            next CMD;
1895        } ## end if (!$file)
1896
1897        # if not in magic file list, try a close match.
1898        if ( !defined $main::{ '_<' . $file } ) {
1899            if ( ($try) = grep( m#^_<.*$file#, keys %main:: ) ) {
1900                {
1901                    $try = substr( $try, 2 );
1902                    print $OUT "Choosing $try matching '$file':\n";
1903                    $file = $try;
1904                }
1905            } ## end if (($try) = grep(m#^_<.*$file#...
1906        } ## end if (!defined $main::{ ...
1907
1908        # If not successfully switched now, we failed.
1909        if ( !defined $main::{ '_<' . $file } ) {
1910            print $OUT "No file matching '$file' is loaded.\n";
1911            next CMD;
1912        }
1913
1914        # We switched, so switch the debugger internals around.
1915        elsif ( $file ne $filename ) {
1916            *dbline   = $main::{ '_<' . $file };
1917            $max      = $#dbline;
1918            $filename = $file;
1919            $start    = 1;
1920            $cmd      = "l";
1921        } ## end elsif ($file ne $filename)
1922
1923        # We didn't switch; say we didn't.
1924        else {
1925            print $OUT "Already in $file.\n";
1926            next CMD;
1927        }
1928    }
1929
1930    return;
1931}
1932
1933sub _DB__handle_dot_command {
1934    my ($obj) = @_;
1935
1936    # . command.
1937    if ($obj->_is_full('.')) {
1938        $incr = -1;    # stay at current line
1939
1940        # Reset everything to the old location.
1941        $start    = $line;
1942        $filename = $filename_ini;
1943        *dbline   = $main::{ '_<' . $filename };
1944        $max      = $#dbline;
1945
1946        # Now where are we?
1947        print_lineinfo($obj->position());
1948        next CMD;
1949    }
1950
1951    return;
1952}
1953
1954sub _DB__handle_y_command {
1955    my ($obj) = @_;
1956
1957    if (my ($match_level, $match_vars)
1958        = $obj->cmd_args =~ /\A(?:(\d*)\s*(.*))?\z/) {
1959
1960        # See if we've got the necessary support.
1961        if (!eval {
1962            local @INC = @INC;
1963            pop @INC if $INC[-1] eq '.';
1964            require PadWalker; PadWalker->VERSION(0.08) }) {
1965            my $Err = $@;
1966            _db_warn(
1967                $Err =~ /locate/
1968                ? "PadWalker module not found - please install\n"
1969                : $Err
1970            );
1971            next CMD;
1972        }
1973
1974        # Load up dumpvar if we don't have it. If we can, that is.
1975        do 'dumpvar.pl' || die $@ unless defined &main::dumpvar;
1976        defined &main::dumpvar
1977            or print $OUT "dumpvar.pl not available.\n"
1978            and next CMD;
1979
1980        # Got all the modules we need. Find them and print them.
1981        my @vars = split( ' ', $match_vars || '' );
1982
1983        # Find the pad.
1984        my $h = eval { PadWalker::peek_my( ( $match_level || 0 ) + 2 ) };
1985
1986        # Oops. Can't find it.
1987        if (my $Err = $@) {
1988            $Err =~ s/ at .*//;
1989            _db_warn($Err);
1990            next CMD;
1991        }
1992
1993        # Show the desired vars with dumplex().
1994        my $savout = select($OUT);
1995
1996        # Have dumplex dump the lexicals.
1997        foreach my $key (sort keys %$h) {
1998            dumpvar::dumplex( $key, $h->{$key},
1999                defined $option{dumpDepth} ? $option{dumpDepth} : -1,
2000                @vars );
2001        }
2002        select($savout);
2003        next CMD;
2004    }
2005}
2006
2007sub _DB__handle_c_command {
2008    my ($obj) = @_;
2009
2010    my $i = $obj->cmd_args;
2011
2012    if ($i =~ m#\A[\w:]*\z#) {
2013
2014        # Hey, show's over. The debugged program finished
2015        # executing already.
2016        next CMD if _DB__is_finished();
2017
2018        # Capture the place to put a one-time break.
2019        $subname = $i;
2020
2021        #  Probably not needed, since we finish an interactive
2022        #  sub-session anyway...
2023        # local $filename = $filename;
2024        # local *dbline = *dbline; # XXX Would this work?!
2025        #
2026        # The above question wonders if localizing the alias
2027        # to the magic array works or not. Since it's commented
2028        # out, we'll just leave that to speculation for now.
2029
2030        # If the "subname" isn't all digits, we'll assume it
2031        # is a subroutine name, and try to find it.
2032        if ( $subname =~ /\D/ ) {    # subroutine name
2033            # Qualify it to the current package unless it's
2034            # already qualified.
2035            $subname = $package . "::" . $subname
2036            unless $subname =~ /::/;
2037
2038            # find_sub will return "file:line_number" corresponding
2039            # to where the subroutine is defined; we call find_sub,
2040            # break up the return value, and assign it in one
2041            # operation.
2042            ( $file, $i ) = ( find_sub($subname) =~ /^(.*):(.*)$/ );
2043
2044            # Force the line number to be numeric.
2045            $i = $i + 0;
2046
2047            # If we got a line number, we found the sub.
2048            if ($i) {
2049
2050                # Switch all the debugger's internals around so
2051                # we're actually working with that file.
2052                $filename = $file;
2053                *dbline   = $main::{ '_<' . $filename };
2054
2055                # Mark that there's a breakpoint in this file.
2056                $had_breakpoints{$filename} |= 1;
2057
2058                # Scan forward to the first executable line
2059                # after the 'sub whatever' line.
2060                $max = $#dbline;
2061                my $_line_num = $i;
2062                while ($dbline[$_line_num] == 0 && $_line_num< $max)
2063                {
2064                    $_line_num++;
2065                }
2066                $i = $_line_num;
2067            } ## end if ($i)
2068
2069            # We didn't find a sub by that name.
2070            else {
2071                print $OUT "Subroutine $subname not found.\n";
2072                next CMD;
2073            }
2074        } ## end if ($subname =~ /\D/)
2075
2076        # At this point, either the subname was all digits (an
2077        # absolute line-break request) or we've scanned through
2078        # the code following the definition of the sub, looking
2079        # for an executable, which we may or may not have found.
2080        #
2081        # If $i (which we set $subname from) is non-zero, we
2082        # got a request to break at some line somewhere. On
2083        # one hand, if there wasn't any real subroutine name
2084        # involved, this will be a request to break in the current
2085        # file at the specified line, so we have to check to make
2086        # sure that the line specified really is breakable.
2087        #
2088        # On the other hand, if there was a subname supplied, the
2089        # preceding block has moved us to the proper file and
2090        # location within that file, and then scanned forward
2091        # looking for the next executable line. We have to make
2092        # sure that one was found.
2093        #
2094        # On the gripping hand, we can't do anything unless the
2095        # current value of $i points to a valid breakable line.
2096        # Check that.
2097        if ($i) {
2098
2099            # Breakable?
2100            if ( $dbline[$i] == 0 ) {
2101                print $OUT "Line $i not breakable.\n";
2102                next CMD;
2103            }
2104
2105            # Yes. Set up the one-time-break sigil.
2106            $dbline{$i} =~ s/($|\0)/;9$1/;  # add one-time-only b.p.
2107            _enable_breakpoint_temp_enabled_status($filename, $i);
2108        } ## end if ($i)
2109
2110        # Turn off stack tracing from here up.
2111        for my $j (0 .. $stack_depth) {
2112            $stack[ $j ] &= ~1;
2113        }
2114        last CMD;
2115    }
2116
2117    return;
2118}
2119
2120sub _DB__handle_forward_slash_command {
2121    my ($obj) = @_;
2122
2123    # The pattern as a string.
2124    use vars qw($inpat);
2125
2126    if (($inpat) = $cmd =~ m#\A/(.*)\z#) {
2127
2128        # Remove the final slash.
2129        $inpat =~ s:([^\\])/$:$1:;
2130
2131        # If the pattern isn't null ...
2132        if ( $inpat ne "" ) {
2133
2134            # Turn off warn and die processing for a bit.
2135            local $SIG{__DIE__};
2136            local $SIG{__WARN__};
2137
2138            # Create the pattern.
2139            eval 'no strict q/vars/; $inpat =~ m' . "\a$inpat\a";
2140            if ( $@ ne "" ) {
2141
2142                # Oops. Bad pattern. No biscuit.
2143                # Print the eval error and go back for more
2144                # commands.
2145                print {$OUT} "$@";
2146                next CMD;
2147            }
2148            $obj->pat($inpat);
2149        } ## end if ($inpat ne "")
2150
2151        # Set up to stop on wrap-around.
2152        $end = $start;
2153
2154        # Don't move off the current line.
2155        $incr = -1;
2156
2157        my $pat = $obj->pat;
2158
2159        # Done in eval so nothing breaks if the pattern
2160        # does something weird.
2161        eval
2162        {
2163            no strict q/vars/;
2164            for (;;) {
2165                # Move ahead one line.
2166                ++$start;
2167
2168                # Wrap if we pass the last line.
2169                if ($start > $max) {
2170                    $start = 1;
2171                }
2172
2173                # Stop if we have gotten back to this line again,
2174                last if ($start == $end);
2175
2176                # A hit! (Note, though, that we are doing
2177                # case-insensitive matching. Maybe a qr//
2178                # expression would be better, so the user could
2179                # do case-sensitive matching if desired.
2180                if ($dbline[$start] =~ m/$pat/i) {
2181                    if ($slave_editor) {
2182                        # Handle proper escaping in the slave.
2183                        print {$OUT} "\032\032$filename:$start:0\n";
2184                    }
2185                    else {
2186                        # Just print the line normally.
2187                        print {$OUT} "$start:\t",$dbline[$start],"\n";
2188                    }
2189                    # And quit since we found something.
2190                    last;
2191                }
2192            }
2193        };
2194
2195        if ($@) {
2196            warn $@;
2197        }
2198
2199        # If we wrapped, there never was a match.
2200        if ( $start == $end ) {
2201            print {$OUT} "/$pat/: not found\n";
2202        }
2203        next CMD;
2204    }
2205
2206    return;
2207}
2208
2209sub _DB__handle_question_mark_command {
2210    my ($obj) = @_;
2211
2212    # ? - backward pattern search.
2213    if (my ($inpat) = $cmd =~ m#\A\?(.*)\z#) {
2214
2215        # Get the pattern, remove trailing question mark.
2216        $inpat =~ s:([^\\])\?$:$1:;
2217
2218        # If we've got one ...
2219        if ( $inpat ne "" ) {
2220
2221            # Turn off die & warn handlers.
2222            local $SIG{__DIE__};
2223            local $SIG{__WARN__};
2224            eval '$inpat =~ m' . "\a$inpat\a";
2225
2226            if ( $@ ne "" ) {
2227
2228                # Ouch. Not good. Print the error.
2229                print $OUT $@;
2230                next CMD;
2231            }
2232            $obj->pat($inpat);
2233        } ## end if ($inpat ne "")
2234
2235        # Where we are now is where to stop after wraparound.
2236        $end = $start;
2237
2238        # Don't move away from this line.
2239        $incr = -1;
2240
2241        my $pat = $obj->pat;
2242        # Search inside the eval to prevent pattern badness
2243        # from killing us.
2244        eval {
2245            no strict q/vars/;
2246            for (;;) {
2247                # Back up a line.
2248                --$start;
2249
2250                # Wrap if we pass the first line.
2251
2252                $start = $max if ($start <= 0);
2253
2254                # Quit if we get back where we started,
2255                last if ($start == $end);
2256
2257                # Match?
2258                if ($dbline[$start] =~ m/$pat/i) {
2259                    if ($slave_editor) {
2260                        # Yep, follow slave editor requirements.
2261                        print $OUT "\032\032$filename:$start:0\n";
2262                    }
2263                    else {
2264                        # Yep, just print normally.
2265                        print $OUT "$start:\t",$dbline[$start],"\n";
2266                    }
2267
2268                    # Found, so done.
2269                    last;
2270                }
2271            }
2272        };
2273
2274        # Say we failed if the loop never found anything,
2275        if ( $start == $end ) {
2276            print {$OUT} "?$pat?: not found\n";
2277        }
2278        next CMD;
2279    }
2280
2281    return;
2282}
2283
2284sub _DB__handle_restart_and_rerun_commands {
2285    my ($obj) = @_;
2286
2287    my $cmd_cmd = $obj->cmd_verb;
2288    my $cmd_params = $obj->cmd_args;
2289    # R - restart execution.
2290    # rerun - controlled restart execution.
2291    if ($cmd_cmd eq 'rerun' or $cmd_params eq '') {
2292
2293        # Change directory to the initial current working directory on
2294        # the script startup, so if the debugged program changed the
2295        # directory, then we will still be able to find the path to the
2296        # the program. (perl 5 RT #121509 ).
2297        chdir ($_initial_cwd);
2298
2299        my @args = ($cmd_cmd eq 'R' ? restart() : rerun($cmd_params));
2300
2301        # Close all non-system fds for a clean restart.  A more
2302        # correct method would be to close all fds that were not
2303        # open when the process started, but this seems to be
2304        # hard.  See "debugger 'R'estart and open database
2305        # connections" on p5p.
2306
2307        my $max_fd = 1024; # default if POSIX can't be loaded
2308        if (eval { require POSIX }) {
2309            eval { $max_fd = POSIX::sysconf(POSIX::_SC_OPEN_MAX()) };
2310        }
2311
2312        if (defined $max_fd) {
2313            foreach ($^F+1 .. $max_fd-1) {
2314                next unless open FD_TO_CLOSE, "<&=$_";
2315                close(FD_TO_CLOSE);
2316            }
2317        }
2318
2319        # And run Perl again.  We use exec() to keep the
2320        # PID stable (and that way $ini_pids is still valid).
2321        exec(@args) or print {$OUT} "exec failed: $!\n";
2322
2323        last CMD;
2324    }
2325
2326    return;
2327}
2328
2329sub _DB__handle_run_command_in_pager_command {
2330    my ($obj) = @_;
2331
2332    if ($cmd =~ m#\A\|\|?\s*[^|]#) {
2333        if ( $pager =~ /^\|/ ) {
2334
2335            # Default pager is into a pipe. Redirect I/O.
2336            open( SAVEOUT, ">&STDOUT" )
2337            || _db_warn("Can't save STDOUT");
2338            open( STDOUT, ">&OUT" )
2339            || _db_warn("Can't redirect STDOUT");
2340        } ## end if ($pager =~ /^\|/)
2341        else {
2342
2343            # Not into a pipe. STDOUT is safe.
2344            open( SAVEOUT, ">&OUT" ) || _db_warn("Can't save DB::OUT");
2345        }
2346
2347        # Fix up environment to record we have less if so.
2348        fix_less();
2349
2350        unless ( $obj->piped(scalar ( open( OUT, $pager ) ) ) ) {
2351
2352            # Couldn't open pipe to pager.
2353            _db_warn("Can't pipe output to '$pager'");
2354            if ( $pager =~ /^\|/ ) {
2355
2356                # Redirect I/O back again.
2357                open( OUT, ">&STDOUT" )    # XXX: lost message
2358                || _db_warn("Can't restore DB::OUT");
2359                open( STDOUT, ">&SAVEOUT" )
2360                || _db_warn("Can't restore STDOUT");
2361                close(SAVEOUT);
2362            } ## end if ($pager =~ /^\|/)
2363            else {
2364
2365                # Redirect I/O. STDOUT already safe.
2366                open( OUT, ">&STDOUT" )    # XXX: lost message
2367                || _db_warn("Can't restore DB::OUT");
2368            }
2369            next CMD;
2370        } ## end unless ($piped = open(OUT,...
2371
2372        # Set up broken-pipe handler if necessary.
2373        $SIG{PIPE} = \&DB::catch
2374        if $pager =~ /^\|/
2375        && ( "" eq $SIG{PIPE} || "DEFAULT" eq $SIG{PIPE} );
2376
2377        _autoflush(\*OUT);
2378        # Save current filehandle, and put it back.
2379        $obj->selected(scalar( select(OUT) ));
2380        # Don't put it back if pager was a pipe.
2381        if ($cmd !~ /\A\|\|/)
2382        {
2383            select($obj->selected());
2384            $obj->selected("");
2385        }
2386
2387        # Trim off the pipe symbols and run the command now.
2388        $cmd =~ s#\A\|+\s*##;
2389        redo PIPE;
2390    }
2391
2392    return;
2393}
2394
2395sub _DB__handle_m_command {
2396    my ($obj) = @_;
2397
2398    if ($cmd =~ s#\Am\s+([\w:]+)\s*\z# #) {
2399        methods($1);
2400        next CMD;
2401    }
2402
2403    # m expr - set up DB::eval to do the work
2404    if ($cmd =~ s#\Am\b# #) {    # Rest gets done by DB::eval()
2405        $onetimeDump = 'methods';   #  method output gets used there
2406    }
2407
2408    return;
2409}
2410
2411sub _DB__at_end_of_every_command {
2412    my ($obj) = @_;
2413
2414    # At the end of every command:
2415    if ($obj->piped) {
2416
2417        # Unhook the pipe mechanism now.
2418        if ( $pager =~ /^\|/ ) {
2419
2420            # No error from the child.
2421            $? = 0;
2422
2423            # we cannot warn here: the handle is missing --tchrist
2424            close(OUT) || print SAVEOUT "\nCan't close DB::OUT\n";
2425
2426            # most of the $? crud was coping with broken cshisms
2427            # $? is explicitly set to 0, so this never runs.
2428            if ($?) {
2429                print SAVEOUT "Pager '$pager' failed: ";
2430                if ( $? == -1 ) {
2431                    print SAVEOUT "shell returned -1\n";
2432                }
2433                elsif ( $? >> 8 ) {
2434                    print SAVEOUT ( $? & 127 )
2435                    ? " (SIG#" . ( $? & 127 ) . ")"
2436                    : "", ( $? & 128 ) ? " -- core dumped" : "", "\n";
2437                }
2438                else {
2439                    print SAVEOUT "status ", ( $? >> 8 ), "\n";
2440                }
2441            } ## end if ($?)
2442
2443            # Reopen filehandle for our output (if we can) and
2444            # restore STDOUT (if we can).
2445            open( OUT, ">&STDOUT" ) || _db_warn("Can't restore DB::OUT");
2446            open( STDOUT, ">&SAVEOUT" )
2447            || _db_warn("Can't restore STDOUT");
2448
2449            # Turn off pipe exception handler if necessary.
2450            $SIG{PIPE} = "DEFAULT" if $SIG{PIPE} eq \&DB::catch;
2451
2452            # Will stop ignoring SIGPIPE if done like nohup(1)
2453            # does SIGINT but Perl doesn't give us a choice.
2454        } ## end if ($pager =~ /^\|/)
2455        else {
2456
2457            # Non-piped "pager". Just restore STDOUT.
2458            open( OUT, ">&SAVEOUT" ) || _db_warn("Can't restore DB::OUT");
2459        }
2460
2461        # Let Readline know about the new filehandles.
2462        reset_IN_OUT( \*IN, \*OUT );
2463
2464        # Close filehandle pager was using, restore the normal one
2465        # if necessary,
2466        close(SAVEOUT);
2467
2468        if ($obj->selected() ne "") {
2469            select($obj->selected);
2470            $obj->selected("");
2471        }
2472
2473        # No pipes now.
2474        $obj->piped("");
2475    } ## end if ($piped)
2476
2477    return;
2478}
2479
2480sub _DB__handle_watch_expressions
2481{
2482    my $self = shift;
2483
2484    if ( $DB::trace & 2 ) {
2485        for my $n (0 .. $#DB::to_watch) {
2486            $DB::evalarg = $DB::to_watch[$n];
2487            local $DB::onetimeDump;    # Tell DB::eval() to not output results
2488
2489            # Fix context DB::eval() wants to return an array, but
2490            # we need a scalar here.
2491            my ($val) = join( "', '", DB::eval(@_) );
2492            $val = ( ( defined $val ) ? "'$val'" : 'undef' );
2493
2494            # Did it change?
2495            if ( $val ne $DB::old_watch[$n] ) {
2496
2497                # Yep! Show the difference, and fake an interrupt.
2498                $DB::signal = 1;
2499                print {$DB::OUT} <<EOP;
2500Watchpoint $n:\t$DB::to_watch[$n] changed:
2501    old value:\t$DB::old_watch[$n]
2502    new value:\t$val
2503EOP
2504                $DB::old_watch[$n] = $val;
2505            } ## end if ($val ne $old_watch...
2506        } ## end for my $n (0 ..
2507    } ## end if ($trace & 2)
2508
2509    return;
2510}
2511
2512# 't' is type.
2513# 'm' is method.
2514# 'v' is the value (i.e: method name or subroutine ref).
2515# 's' is subroutine.
2516my %cmd_lookup;
2517
2518BEGIN
2519{
2520    %cmd_lookup =
2521(
2522    '-' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_dash_command', },
2523    '.' => { t => 's', v => \&_DB__handle_dot_command, },
2524    '=' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_equal_sign_command', },
2525    'H' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_H_command', },
2526    'S' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_S_command', },
2527    'T' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_T_command', },
2528    'W' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_W_command', },
2529    'c' => { t => 's', v => \&_DB__handle_c_command, },
2530    'f' => { t => 's', v => \&_DB__handle_f_command, },
2531    'm' => { t => 's', v => \&_DB__handle_m_command, },
2532    'n' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_n_command', },
2533    'p' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_p_command', },
2534    'q' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_q_command', },
2535    'r' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_r_command', },
2536    's' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_s_command', },
2537    'save' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_save_command', },
2538    'source' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_source_command', },
2539    't' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_t_command', },
2540    'w' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_w_command', },
2541    'x' => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_x_command', },
2542    'y' => { t => 's', v => \&_DB__handle_y_command, },
2543    (map { $_ => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_V_command_and_X_command', }, }
2544        ('X', 'V')),
2545    (map { $_ => { t => 'm', v => '_handle_enable_disable_commands', }, }
2546        qw(enable disable)),
2547    (map { $_ =>
2548        { t => 's', v => \&_DB__handle_restart_and_rerun_commands, },
2549        } qw(R rerun)),
2550    (map { $_ => {t => 'm', v => '_handle_cmd_wrapper_commands' }, }
2551        qw(a A b B e E h i l L M o O v w W)),
2552);
2553};
2554
2555sub DB {
2556
2557    # lock the debugger and get the thread id for the prompt
2558    lock($DBGR);
2559    my $tid;
2560    my $position;
2561    my ($prefix, $after, $infix);
2562    my $pat;
2563    my $explicit_stop;
2564    my $piped;
2565    my $selected;
2566
2567    if ($ENV{PERL5DB_THREADED}) {
2568        $tid = eval { "[".threads->tid."]" };
2569    }
2570
2571    my $cmd_verb;
2572    my $cmd_args;
2573
2574    my $obj = DB::Obj->new(
2575        {
2576            position => \$position,
2577            prefix => \$prefix,
2578            after => \$after,
2579            explicit_stop => \$explicit_stop,
2580            infix => \$infix,
2581            cmd_args => \$cmd_args,
2582            cmd_verb => \$cmd_verb,
2583            pat => \$pat,
2584            piped => \$piped,
2585            selected => \$selected,
2586        },
2587    );
2588
2589    $obj->_DB_on_init__initialize_globals(@_);
2590
2591    # Preserve current values of $@, $!, $^E, $,, $/, $\, $^W.
2592    # The code being debugged may have altered them.
2593    DB::save();
2594
2595    # Since DB::DB gets called after every line, we can use caller() to
2596    # figure out where we last were executing. Sneaky, eh? This works because
2597    # caller is returning all the extra information when called from the
2598    # debugger.
2599    local ( $package, $filename, $line ) = caller;
2600    $filename_ini = $filename;
2601
2602    # set up the context for DB::eval, so it can properly execute
2603    # code on behalf of the user. We add the package in so that the
2604    # code is eval'ed in the proper package (not in the debugger!).
2605    local $usercontext = _calc_usercontext($package);
2606
2607    # Create an alias to the active file magical array to simplify
2608    # the code here.
2609    local (*dbline) = $main::{ '_<' . $filename };
2610
2611    # Last line in the program.
2612    $max = $#dbline;
2613
2614    # The &-call is here to ascertain the mutability of @_.
2615    &_DB__determine_if_we_should_break;
2616
2617    # Preserve the current stop-or-not, and see if any of the W
2618    # (watch expressions) has changed.
2619    my $was_signal = $signal;
2620
2621    # If we have any watch expressions ...
2622    _DB__handle_watch_expressions($obj);
2623
2624=head2 C<watchfunction()>
2625
2626C<watchfunction()> is a function that can be defined by the user; it is a
2627function which will be run on each entry to C<DB::DB>; it gets the
2628current package, filename, and line as its parameters.
2629
2630The watchfunction can do anything it likes; it is executing in the
2631debugger's context, so it has access to all of the debugger's internal
2632data structures and functions.
2633
2634C<watchfunction()> can control the debugger's actions. Any of the following
2635will cause the debugger to return control to the user's program after
2636C<watchfunction()> executes:
2637
2638=over 4
2639
2640=item *
2641
2642Returning a false value from the C<watchfunction()> itself.
2643
2644=item *
2645
2646Altering C<$single> to a false value.
2647
2648=item *
2649
2650Altering C<$signal> to a false value.
2651
2652=item *
2653
2654Turning off the C<4> bit in C<$trace> (this also disables the
2655check for C<watchfunction()>. This can be done with
2656
2657    $trace &= ~4;
2658
2659=back
2660
2661=cut
2662
2663    # If there's a user-defined DB::watchfunction, call it with the
2664    # current package, filename, and line. The function executes in
2665    # the DB:: package.
2666    if ( $trace & 4 ) {    # User-installed watch
2667        return
2668          if watchfunction( $package, $filename, $line )
2669          and not $single
2670          and not $was_signal
2671          and not( $trace & ~4 );
2672    } ## end if ($trace & 4)
2673
2674    # Pick up any alteration to $signal in the watchfunction, and
2675    # turn off the signal now.
2676    $was_signal = $signal;
2677    $signal     = 0;
2678
2679=head2 GETTING READY TO EXECUTE COMMANDS
2680
2681The debugger decides to take control if single-step mode is on, the
2682C<t> command was entered, or the user generated a signal. If the program
2683has fallen off the end, we set things up so that entering further commands
2684won't cause trouble, and we say that the program is over.
2685
2686=cut
2687
2688    # Make sure that we always print if asked for explicitly regardless
2689    # of $trace_to_depth .
2690    $explicit_stop = ($single || $was_signal);
2691
2692    # Check to see if we should grab control ($single true,
2693    # trace set appropriately, or we got a signal).
2694    if ( $explicit_stop || ( $trace & 1 ) ) {
2695        $obj->_DB__grab_control(@_);
2696    } ## end if ($single || ($trace...
2697
2698=pod
2699
2700If there's an action to be executed for the line we stopped at, execute it.
2701If there are any preprompt actions, execute those as well.
2702
2703=cut
2704
2705    # If there's an action, do it now.
2706    if ($action) {
2707        $evalarg = $action;
2708        # The &-call is here to ascertain the mutability of @_.
2709        &DB::eval;
2710    }
2711
2712    # Are we nested another level (e.g., did we evaluate a function
2713    # that had a breakpoint in it at the debugger prompt)?
2714    if ( $single || $was_signal ) {
2715
2716        # Yes, go down a level.
2717        local $level = $level + 1;
2718
2719        # Do any pre-prompt actions.
2720        foreach $evalarg (@$pre) {
2721            # The &-call is here to ascertain the mutability of @_.
2722            &DB::eval;
2723        }
2724
2725        # Complain about too much recursion if we passed the limit.
2726        if ($single & 4) {
2727            print $OUT $stack_depth . " levels deep in subroutine calls!\n";
2728        }
2729
2730        # The line we're currently on. Set $incr to -1 to stay here
2731        # until we get a command that tells us to advance.
2732        $start = $line;
2733        $incr  = -1;      # for backward motion.
2734
2735        # Tack preprompt debugger actions ahead of any actual input.
2736        @typeahead = ( @$pretype, @typeahead );
2737
2738=head2 WHERE ARE WE?
2739
2740XXX Relocate this section?
2741
2742The debugger normally shows the line corresponding to the current line of
2743execution. Sometimes, though, we want to see the next line, or to move elsewhere
2744in the file. This is done via the C<$incr>, C<$start>, and C<$max> variables.
2745
2746C<$incr> controls by how many lines the I<current> line should move forward
2747after a command is executed. If set to -1, this indicates that the I<current>
2748line shouldn't change.
2749
2750C<$start> is the I<current> line. It is used for things like knowing where to
2751move forwards or backwards from when doing an C<L> or C<-> command.
2752
2753C<$max> tells the debugger where the last line of the current file is. It's
2754used to terminate loops most often.
2755
2756=head2 THE COMMAND LOOP
2757
2758Most of C<DB::DB> is actually a command parsing and dispatch loop. It comes
2759in two parts:
2760
2761=over 4
2762
2763=item *
2764
2765The outer part of the loop, starting at the C<CMD> label. This loop
2766reads a command and then executes it.
2767
2768=item *
2769
2770The inner part of the loop, starting at the C<PIPE> label. This part
2771is wholly contained inside the C<CMD> block and only executes a command.
2772Used to handle commands running inside a pager.
2773
2774=back
2775
2776So why have two labels to restart the loop? Because sometimes, it's easier to
2777have a command I<generate> another command and then re-execute the loop to do
2778the new command. This is faster, but perhaps a bit more convoluted.
2779
2780=cut
2781
2782        # The big command dispatch loop. It keeps running until the
2783        # user yields up control again.
2784        #
2785        # If we have a terminal for input, and we get something back
2786        # from readline(), keep on processing.
2787
2788      CMD:
2789        while (_DB__read_next_cmd($tid))
2790        {
2791
2792            share($cmd);
2793            # ... try to execute the input as debugger commands.
2794
2795            # Don't stop running.
2796            $single = 0;
2797
2798            # No signal is active.
2799            $signal = 0;
2800
2801            # Handle continued commands (ending with \):
2802            if ($cmd =~ s/\\\z/\n/) {
2803                $cmd .= DB::readline("  cont: ");
2804                redo CMD;
2805            }
2806
2807=head4 The null command
2808
2809A newline entered by itself means I<re-execute the last command>. We grab the
2810command out of C<$laststep> (where it was recorded previously), and copy it
2811back into C<$cmd> to be executed below. If there wasn't any previous command,
2812we'll do nothing below (no command will match). If there was, we also save it
2813in the command history and fall through to allow the command parsing to pick
2814it up.
2815
2816=cut
2817
2818            # Empty input means repeat the last command.
2819            if ($cmd eq '') {
2820                $cmd = $laststep;
2821            }
2822            chomp($cmd);    # get rid of the annoying extra newline
2823            if (length($cmd) >= 2) {
2824                push( @hist, $cmd );
2825            }
2826            push( @truehist, $cmd );
2827            share(@hist);
2828            share(@truehist);
2829
2830            # This is a restart point for commands that didn't arrive
2831            # via direct user input. It allows us to 'redo PIPE' to
2832            # re-execute command processing without reading a new command.
2833          PIPE: {
2834                _DB__trim_command_and_return_first_component($obj);
2835
2836=head3 COMMAND ALIASES
2837
2838The debugger can create aliases for commands (these are stored in the
2839C<%alias> hash). Before a command is executed, the command loop looks it up
2840in the alias hash and substitutes the contents of the alias for the command,
2841completely replacing it.
2842
2843=cut
2844
2845                # See if there's an alias for the command, and set it up if so.
2846                if ( $alias{$cmd_verb} ) {
2847
2848                    # Squelch signal handling; we want to keep control here
2849                    # if something goes loco during the alias eval.
2850                    local $SIG{__DIE__};
2851                    local $SIG{__WARN__};
2852
2853                    # This is a command, so we eval it in the DEBUGGER's
2854                    # scope! Otherwise, we can't see the special debugger
2855                    # variables, or get to the debugger's subs. (Well, we
2856                    # _could_, but why make it even more complicated?)
2857                    eval "\$cmd =~ $alias{$cmd_verb}";
2858                    if ($@) {
2859                        local $\ = '';
2860                        print $OUT "Couldn't evaluate '$cmd_verb' alias: $@";
2861                        next CMD;
2862                    }
2863                    _DB__trim_command_and_return_first_component($obj);
2864                } ## end if ($alias{$cmd_verb})
2865
2866=head3 MAIN-LINE COMMANDS
2867
2868All of these commands work up to and after the program being debugged has
2869terminated.
2870
2871=head4 C<q> - quit
2872
2873Quit the debugger. This entails setting the C<$fall_off_end> flag, so we don't
2874try to execute further, cleaning any restart-related stuff out of the
2875environment, and executing with the last value of C<$?>.
2876
2877=cut
2878
2879                # All of these commands were remapped in perl 5.8.0;
2880                # we send them off to the secondary dispatcher (see below).
2881                $obj->_handle_special_char_cmd_wrapper_commands;
2882                _DB__trim_command_and_return_first_component($obj);
2883
2884                if (my $cmd_rec = $cmd_lookup{$cmd_verb}) {
2885                    my $type = $cmd_rec->{t};
2886                    my $val = $cmd_rec->{v};
2887                    if ($type eq 'm') {
2888                        $obj->$val();
2889                    }
2890                    elsif ($type eq 's') {
2891                        $val->($obj);
2892                    }
2893                }
2894
2895=head4 C<t> - trace [n]
2896
2897Turn tracing on or off. Inverts the appropriate bit in C<$trace> (q.v.).
2898If level is specified, set C<$trace_to_depth>.
2899
2900=head4 C<S> - list subroutines matching/not matching a pattern
2901
2902Walks through C<%sub>, checking to see whether or not to print the name.
2903
2904=head4 C<X> - list variables in current package
2905
2906Since the C<V> command actually processes this, just change this to the
2907appropriate C<V> command and fall through.
2908
2909=head4 C<V> - list variables
2910
2911Uses C<dumpvar.pl> to dump out the current values for selected variables.
2912
2913=head4 C<x> - evaluate and print an expression
2914
2915Hands the expression off to C<DB::eval>, setting it up to print the value
2916via C<dumpvar.pl> instead of just printing it directly.
2917
2918=head4 C<m> - print methods
2919
2920Just uses C<DB::methods> to determine what methods are available.
2921
2922=head4 C<f> - switch files
2923
2924Switch to a different filename.
2925
2926=head4 C<.> - return to last-executed line.
2927
2928We set C<$incr> to -1 to indicate that the debugger shouldn't move ahead,
2929and then we look up the line in the magical C<%dbline> hash.
2930
2931=head4 C<-> - back one window
2932
2933We change C<$start> to be one window back; if we go back past the first line,
2934we set it to be the first line. We set C<$incr> to put us back at the
2935currently-executing line, and then put a C<l $start +> (list one window from
2936C<$start>) in C<$cmd> to be executed later.
2937
2938=head3 PRE-580 COMMANDS VS. NEW COMMANDS: C<a, A, b, B, h, l, L, M, o, O, P, v, w, W, E<lt>, E<lt>E<lt>, E<0x7B>, E<0x7B>E<0x7B>>
2939
2940In Perl 5.8.0, a realignment of the commands was done to fix up a number of
2941problems, most notably that the default case of several commands destroying
2942the user's work in setting watchpoints, actions, etc. We wanted, however, to
2943retain the old commands for those who were used to using them or who preferred
2944them. At this point, we check for the new commands and call C<cmd_wrapper> to
2945deal with them instead of processing them in-line.
2946
2947=head4 C<y> - List lexicals in higher scope
2948
2949Uses C<PadWalker> to find the lexicals supplied as arguments in a scope
2950above the current one and then displays then using C<dumpvar.pl>.
2951
2952=head3 COMMANDS NOT WORKING AFTER PROGRAM ENDS
2953
2954All of the commands below this point don't work after the program being
2955debugged has ended. All of them check to see if the program has ended; this
2956allows the commands to be relocated without worrying about a 'line of
2957demarcation' above which commands can be entered anytime, and below which
2958they can't.
2959
2960=head4 C<n> - single step, but don't trace down into subs
2961
2962Done by setting C<$single> to 2, which forces subs to execute straight through
2963when entered (see C<DB::sub>). We also save the C<n> command in C<$laststep>,
2964so a null command knows what to re-execute.
2965
2966=head4 C<s> - single-step, entering subs
2967
2968Sets C<$single> to 1, which causes C<DB::sub> to continue tracing inside
2969subs. Also saves C<s> as C<$lastcmd>.
2970
2971=head4 C<c> - run continuously, setting an optional breakpoint
2972
2973Most of the code for this command is taken up with locating the optional
2974breakpoint, which is either a subroutine name or a line number. We set
2975the appropriate one-time-break in C<@dbline> and then turn off single-stepping
2976in this and all call levels above this one.
2977
2978=head4 C<r> - return from a subroutine
2979
2980For C<r> to work properly, the debugger has to stop execution again
2981immediately after the return is executed. This is done by forcing
2982single-stepping to be on in the call level above the current one. If
2983we are printing return values when a C<r> is executed, set C<$doret>
2984appropriately, and force us out of the command loop.
2985
2986=head4 C<T> - stack trace
2987
2988Just calls C<DB::print_trace>.
2989
2990=head4 C<w> - List window around current line.
2991
2992Just calls C<DB::cmd_w>.
2993
2994=head4 C<W> - watch-expression processing.
2995
2996Just calls C<DB::cmd_W>.
2997
2998=head4 C</> - search forward for a string in the source
2999
3000We take the argument and treat it as a pattern. If it turns out to be a
3001bad one, we return the error we got from trying to C<eval> it and exit.
3002If not, we create some code to do the search and C<eval> it so it can't
3003mess us up.
3004
3005=cut
3006
3007                _DB__handle_forward_slash_command($obj);
3008
3009=head4 C<?> - search backward for a string in the source
3010
3011Same as for C</>, except the loop runs backwards.
3012
3013=cut
3014
3015                _DB__handle_question_mark_command($obj);
3016
3017=head4 C<$rc> - Recall command
3018
3019Manages the commands in C<@hist> (which is created if C<Term::ReadLine> reports
3020that the terminal supports history). It finds the command required, puts it
3021into C<$cmd>, and redoes the loop to execute it.
3022
3023=cut
3024
3025                # $rc - recall command.
3026                $obj->_handle_rc_recall_command;
3027
3028=head4 C<$sh$sh> - C<system()> command
3029
3030Calls the C<_db_system()> to handle the command. This keeps the C<STDIN> and
3031C<STDOUT> from getting messed up.
3032
3033=cut
3034
3035                $obj->_handle_sh_command;
3036
3037=head4 C<$rc I<pattern> $rc> - Search command history
3038
3039Another command to manipulate C<@hist>: this one searches it with a pattern.
3040If a command is found, it is placed in C<$cmd> and executed via C<redo>.
3041
3042=cut
3043
3044                $obj->_handle_rc_search_history_command;
3045
3046=head4 C<$sh> - Invoke a shell
3047
3048Uses C<_db_system()> to invoke a shell.
3049
3050=cut
3051
3052=head4 C<$sh I<command>> - Force execution of a command in a shell
3053
3054Like the above, but the command is passed to the shell. Again, we use
3055C<_db_system()> to avoid problems with C<STDIN> and C<STDOUT>.
3056
3057=head4 C<H> - display commands in history
3058
3059Prints the contents of C<@hist> (if any).
3060
3061=head4 C<man, doc, perldoc> - look up documentation
3062
3063Just calls C<runman()> to print the appropriate document.
3064
3065=cut
3066
3067                $obj->_handle_doc_command;
3068
3069=head4 C<p> - print
3070
3071Builds a C<print EXPR> expression in the C<$cmd>; this will get executed at
3072the bottom of the loop.
3073
3074=head4 C<=> - define command alias
3075
3076Manipulates C<%alias> to add or list command aliases.
3077
3078=head4 C<source> - read commands from a file.
3079
3080Opens a lexical filehandle and stacks it on C<@cmdfhs>; C<DB::readline> will
3081pick it up.
3082
3083=head4 C<enable> C<disable> - enable or disable breakpoints
3084
3085This enables or disables breakpoints.
3086
3087=head4 C<save> - send current history to a file
3088
3089Takes the complete history, (not the shrunken version you see with C<H>),
3090and saves it to the given filename, so it can be replayed using C<source>.
3091
3092Note that all C<^(save|source)>'s are commented out with a view to minimise recursion.
3093
3094=head4 C<R> - restart
3095
3096Restart the debugger session.
3097
3098=head4 C<rerun> - rerun the current session
3099
3100Return to any given position in the B<true>-history list
3101
3102=head4 C<|, ||> - pipe output through the pager.
3103
3104For C<|>, we save C<OUT> (the debugger's output filehandle) and C<STDOUT>
3105(the program's standard output). For C<||>, we only save C<OUT>. We open a
3106pipe to the pager (restoring the output filehandles if this fails). If this
3107is the C<|> command, we also set up a C<SIGPIPE> handler which will simply
3108set C<$signal>, sending us back into the debugger.
3109
3110We then trim off the pipe symbols and C<redo> the command loop at the
3111C<PIPE> label, causing us to evaluate the command in C<$cmd> without
3112reading another.
3113
3114=cut
3115
3116                # || - run command in the pager, with output to DB::OUT.
3117                _DB__handle_run_command_in_pager_command($obj);
3118
3119=head3 END OF COMMAND PARSING
3120
3121Anything left in C<$cmd> at this point is a Perl expression that we want to
3122evaluate. We'll always evaluate in the user's context, and fully qualify
3123any variables we might want to address in the C<DB> package.
3124
3125=cut
3126
3127            }    # PIPE:
3128
3129            # trace an expression
3130            $cmd =~ s/^t\s/\$DB::trace |= 1;\n/;
3131
3132            # Make sure the flag that says "the debugger's running" is
3133            # still on, to make sure we get control again.
3134            $evalarg = "\$^D = \$^D | \$DB::db_stop;\n$cmd";
3135
3136            # Run *our* eval that executes in the caller's context.
3137            # The &-call is here to ascertain the mutability of @_.
3138            &DB::eval;
3139
3140            # Turn off the one-time-dump stuff now.
3141            if ($onetimeDump) {
3142                $onetimeDump      = undef;
3143                $onetimedumpDepth = undef;
3144            }
3145            elsif ( $term_pid == $$ ) {
3146                eval { # May run under miniperl, when not available...
3147                    STDOUT->flush();
3148                    STDERR->flush();
3149                };
3150
3151                # XXX If this is the master pid, print a newline.
3152                print {$OUT} "\n";
3153            }
3154        } ## end while (($term || &setterm...
3155
3156=head3 POST-COMMAND PROCESSING
3157
3158After each command, we check to see if the command output was piped anywhere.
3159If so, we go through the necessary code to unhook the pipe and go back to
3160our standard filehandles for input and output.
3161
3162=cut
3163
3164        continue {    # CMD:
3165            _DB__at_end_of_every_command($obj);
3166        }    # CMD:
3167
3168=head3 COMMAND LOOP TERMINATION
3169
3170When commands have finished executing, we come here. If the user closed the
3171input filehandle, we turn on C<$fall_off_end> to emulate a C<q> command. We
3172evaluate any post-prompt items. We restore C<$@>, C<$!>, C<$^E>, C<$,>, C<$/>,
3173C<$\>, and C<$^W>, and return a null list as expected by the Perl interpreter.
3174The interpreter will then execute the next line and then return control to us
3175again.
3176
3177=cut
3178
3179        # No more commands? Quit.
3180        $fall_off_end = 1 unless defined $cmd;    # Emulate 'q' on EOF
3181
3182        # Evaluate post-prompt commands.
3183        foreach $evalarg (@$post) {
3184            # The &-call is here to ascertain the mutability of @_.
3185            &DB::eval;
3186        }
3187    }    # if ($single || $signal)
3188
3189    # Put the user's globals back where you found them.
3190    ( $@, $!, $^E, $,, $/, $\, $^W ) = @saved;
3191    ();
3192} ## end sub DB
3193
3194# Because DB::Obj is used above,
3195#
3196#   my $obj = DB::Obj->new(
3197#
3198# The following package declaration must come before that,
3199# or else runtime errors will occur with
3200#
3201#   PERLDB_OPTS="autotrace nonstop"
3202#
3203# ( rt#116771 )
3204BEGIN {
3205
3206package DB::Obj;
3207
3208sub new {
3209    my $class = shift;
3210
3211    my $self = bless {}, $class;
3212
3213    $self->_init(@_);
3214
3215    return $self;
3216}
3217
3218sub _init {
3219    my ($self, $args) = @_;
3220
3221    %{$self} = (%$self, %$args);
3222
3223    return;
3224}
3225
3226{
3227    no strict 'refs';
3228    foreach my $slot_name (qw(
3229        after explicit_stop infix pat piped position prefix selected cmd_verb
3230        cmd_args
3231        )) {
3232        my $slot = $slot_name;
3233        *{$slot} = sub {
3234            my $self = shift;
3235
3236            if (@_) {
3237                ${ $self->{$slot} } = shift;
3238            }
3239
3240            return ${ $self->{$slot} };
3241        };
3242
3243        *{"append_to_$slot"} = sub {
3244            my $self = shift;
3245            my $s = shift;
3246
3247            return $self->$slot($self->$slot . $s);
3248        };
3249    }
3250}
3251
3252sub _DB_on_init__initialize_globals
3253{
3254    my $self = shift;
3255
3256    # Check for whether we should be running continuously or not.
3257    # _After_ the perl program is compiled, $single is set to 1:
3258    if ( $single and not $second_time++ ) {
3259
3260        # Options say run non-stop. Run until we get an interrupt.
3261        if ($runnonstop) {    # Disable until signal
3262                # If there's any call stack in place, turn off single
3263                # stepping into subs throughout the stack.
3264            for my $i (0 .. $stack_depth) {
3265                $stack[ $i ] &= ~1;
3266            }
3267
3268            # And we are now no longer in single-step mode.
3269            $single = 0;
3270
3271            # If we simply returned at this point, we wouldn't get
3272            # the trace info. Fall on through.
3273            # return;
3274        } ## end if ($runnonstop)
3275
3276        elsif ($ImmediateStop) {
3277
3278            # We are supposed to stop here; XXX probably a break.
3279            $ImmediateStop = 0;    # We've processed it; turn it off
3280            $signal        = 1;    # Simulate an interrupt to force
3281                                   # us into the command loop
3282        }
3283    } ## end if ($single and not $second_time...
3284
3285    # If we're in single-step mode, or an interrupt (real or fake)
3286    # has occurred, turn off non-stop mode.
3287    $runnonstop = 0 if $single or $signal;
3288
3289    return;
3290}
3291
3292sub _my_print_lineinfo
3293{
3294    my ($self, $i, $incr_pos) = @_;
3295
3296    if ($frame) {
3297        # Print it indented if tracing is on.
3298        DB::print_lineinfo( ' ' x $stack_depth,
3299            "$i:\t$DB::dbline[$i]" . $self->after );
3300    }
3301    else {
3302        DB::depth_print_lineinfo($self->explicit_stop, $incr_pos);
3303    }
3304}
3305
3306sub _curr_line {
3307    return $DB::dbline[$line];
3308}
3309
3310sub _is_full {
3311    my ($self, $letter) = @_;
3312
3313    return ($DB::cmd eq $letter);
3314}
3315
3316sub _DB__grab_control
3317{
3318    my $self = shift;
3319
3320    # Yes, grab control.
3321    if ($slave_editor) {
3322
3323        # Tell the editor to update its position.
3324        $self->position("\032\032${DB::filename}:$line:0\n");
3325        DB::print_lineinfo($self->position());
3326    }
3327
3328=pod
3329
3330Special check: if we're in package C<DB::fake>, we've gone through the
3331C<END> block at least once. We set up everything so that we can continue
3332to enter commands and have a valid context to be in.
3333
3334=cut
3335
3336    elsif ( $DB::package eq 'DB::fake' ) {
3337
3338        # Fallen off the end already.
3339        if (!$DB::term) {
3340            DB::setterm();
3341        }
3342
3343        DB::print_help(<<EOP);
3344Debugged program terminated.  Use B<q> to quit or B<R> to restart,
3345use B<o> I<inhibit_exit> to avoid stopping after program termination,
3346B<h q>, B<h R> or B<h o> to get additional info.
3347EOP
3348
3349        # Set the DB::eval context appropriately.
3350        # At program termination disable any user actions.
3351        $DB::action = undef;
3352
3353        $DB::package     = 'main';
3354        $DB::usercontext = DB::_calc_usercontext($DB::package);
3355    } ## end elsif ($package eq 'DB::fake')
3356
3357=pod
3358
3359If the program hasn't finished executing, we scan forward to the
3360next executable line, print that out, build the prompt from the file and line
3361number information, and print that.
3362
3363=cut
3364
3365    else {
3366
3367
3368        # Still somewhere in the midst of execution. Set up the
3369        #  debugger prompt.
3370        $DB::sub =~ s/\'/::/;    # Swap Perl 4 package separators (') to
3371                             # Perl 5 ones (sorry, we don't print Klingon
3372                             #module names)
3373
3374        $self->prefix($DB::sub =~ /::/ ? "" : ($DB::package . '::'));
3375        $self->append_to_prefix( "$DB::sub(${DB::filename}:" );
3376        $self->after( $self->_curr_line =~ /\n$/ ? '' : "\n" );
3377
3378        # Break up the prompt if it's really long.
3379        if ( length($self->prefix()) > 30 ) {
3380            $self->position($self->prefix . "$line):\n$line:\t" . $self->_curr_line . $self->after);
3381            $self->prefix("");
3382            $self->infix(":\t");
3383        }
3384        else {
3385            $self->infix("):\t");
3386            $self->position(
3387                $self->prefix . $line. $self->infix
3388                . $self->_curr_line . $self->after
3389            );
3390        }
3391
3392        # Print current line info, indenting if necessary.
3393        $self->_my_print_lineinfo($line, $self->position);
3394
3395        my $i;
3396        my $line_i = sub { return $DB::dbline[$i]; };
3397
3398        # Scan forward, stopping at either the end or the next
3399        # unbreakable line.
3400        for ( $i = $line + 1 ; $i <= $DB::max && $line_i->() == 0 ; ++$i )
3401        {    #{ vi
3402
3403            # Drop out on null statements, block closers, and comments.
3404            last if $line_i->() =~ /^\s*[\;\}\#\n]/;
3405
3406            # Drop out if the user interrupted us.
3407            last if $signal;
3408
3409            # Append a newline if the line doesn't have one. Can happen
3410            # in eval'ed text, for instance.
3411            $self->after( $line_i->() =~ /\n$/ ? '' : "\n" );
3412
3413            # Next executable line.
3414            my $incr_pos = $self->prefix . $i . $self->infix . $line_i->()
3415                . $self->after;
3416            $self->append_to_position($incr_pos);
3417            $self->_my_print_lineinfo($i, $incr_pos);
3418        } ## end for ($i = $line + 1 ; $i...
3419    } ## end else [ if ($slave_editor)
3420
3421    return;
3422}
3423
3424sub _handle_t_command {
3425    my $self = shift;
3426
3427    my $levels = $self->cmd_args();
3428
3429    if ((!length($levels)) or ($levels !~ /\D/)) {
3430        $trace ^= 1;
3431        local $\ = '';
3432        $DB::trace_to_depth = $levels ? $stack_depth + $levels : 1E9;
3433        print {$OUT} "Trace = "
3434        . ( ( $trace & 1 )
3435            ? ( $levels ? "on (to level $DB::trace_to_depth)" : "on" )
3436            : "off" ) . "\n";
3437        next CMD;
3438    }
3439
3440    return;
3441}
3442
3443
3444sub _handle_S_command {
3445    my $self = shift;
3446
3447    if (my ($print_all_subs, $should_reverse, $Spatt)
3448        = $self->cmd_args =~ /\A((!)?(.+))?\z/) {
3449        # $Spatt is the pattern (if any) to use.
3450        # Reverse scan?
3451        my $Srev     = defined $should_reverse;
3452        # No args - print all subs.
3453        my $Snocheck = !defined $print_all_subs;
3454
3455        # Need to make these sane here.
3456        local $\ = '';
3457        local $, = '';
3458
3459        # Search through the debugger's magical hash of subs.
3460        # If $nocheck is true, just print the sub name.
3461        # Otherwise, check it against the pattern. We then use
3462        # the XOR trick to reverse the condition as required.
3463        foreach $subname ( sort( keys %sub ) ) {
3464            if ( $Snocheck or $Srev ^ ( $subname =~ /$Spatt/ ) ) {
3465                print $OUT $subname, "\n";
3466            }
3467        }
3468        next CMD;
3469    }
3470
3471    return;
3472}
3473
3474sub _handle_V_command_and_X_command {
3475    my $self = shift;
3476
3477    $DB::cmd =~ s/^X\b/V $DB::package/;
3478
3479    # Bare V commands get the currently-being-debugged package
3480    # added.
3481    if ($self->_is_full('V')) {
3482        $DB::cmd = "V $DB::package";
3483    }
3484
3485    # V - show variables in package.
3486    if (my ($new_packname, $new_vars_str) =
3487        $DB::cmd =~ /\AV\b\s*(\S+)\s*(.*)/) {
3488
3489        # Save the currently selected filehandle and
3490        # force output to debugger's filehandle (dumpvar
3491        # just does "print" for output).
3492        my $savout = select($OUT);
3493
3494        # Grab package name and variables to dump.
3495        $packname = $new_packname;
3496        my @vars     = split( ' ', $new_vars_str );
3497
3498        # If main::dumpvar isn't here, get it.
3499        do 'dumpvar.pl' || die $@ unless defined &main::dumpvar;
3500        if ( defined &main::dumpvar ) {
3501
3502            # We got it. Turn off subroutine entry/exit messages
3503            # for the moment, along with return values.
3504            local $frame = 0;
3505            local $doret = -2;
3506
3507            # must detect sigpipe failures  - not catching
3508            # then will cause the debugger to die.
3509            eval {
3510                main::dumpvar(
3511                    $packname,
3512                    defined $option{dumpDepth}
3513                    ? $option{dumpDepth}
3514                    : -1,    # assume -1 unless specified
3515                    @vars
3516                );
3517            };
3518
3519            # The die doesn't need to include the $@, because
3520            # it will automatically get propagated for us.
3521            if ($@) {
3522                die unless $@ =~ /dumpvar print failed/;
3523            }
3524        } ## end if (defined &main::dumpvar)
3525        else {
3526
3527            # Couldn't load dumpvar.
3528            print $OUT "dumpvar.pl not available.\n";
3529        }
3530
3531        # Restore the output filehandle, and go round again.
3532        select($savout);
3533        next CMD;
3534    }
3535
3536    return;
3537}
3538
3539sub _handle_dash_command {
3540    my $self = shift;
3541
3542    if ($self->_is_full('-')) {
3543
3544        # back up by a window; go to 1 if back too far.
3545        $start -= $incr + $window + 1;
3546        $start = 1 if $start <= 0;
3547        $incr  = $window - 1;
3548
3549        # Generate and execute a "l +" command (handled below).
3550        $DB::cmd = 'l ' . ($start) . '+';
3551        redo CMD;
3552    }
3553    return;
3554}
3555
3556sub _n_or_s_commands_generic {
3557    my ($self, $new_val) = @_;
3558    # n - next
3559    next CMD if DB::_DB__is_finished();
3560
3561    # Single step, but don't enter subs.
3562    $single = $new_val;
3563
3564    # Save for empty command (repeat last).
3565    $laststep = $DB::cmd;
3566    last CMD;
3567}
3568
3569sub _n_or_s {
3570    my ($self, $letter, $new_val) = @_;
3571
3572    if ($self->_is_full($letter)) {
3573        $self->_n_or_s_commands_generic($new_val);
3574    }
3575    else {
3576        $self->_n_or_s_and_arg_commands_generic($letter, $new_val);
3577    }
3578
3579    return;
3580}
3581
3582sub _handle_n_command {
3583    my $self = shift;
3584
3585    return $self->_n_or_s('n', 2);
3586}
3587
3588sub _handle_s_command {
3589    my $self = shift;
3590
3591    return $self->_n_or_s('s', 1);
3592}
3593
3594sub _handle_r_command {
3595    my $self = shift;
3596
3597    # r - return from the current subroutine.
3598    if ($self->_is_full('r')) {
3599
3600        # Can't do anything if the program's over.
3601        next CMD if DB::_DB__is_finished();
3602
3603        # Turn on stack trace.
3604        $stack[$stack_depth] |= 1;
3605
3606        # Print return value unless the stack is empty.
3607        $doret = $option{PrintRet} ? $stack_depth - 1 : -2;
3608        last CMD;
3609    }
3610
3611    return;
3612}
3613
3614sub _handle_T_command {
3615    my $self = shift;
3616
3617    if ($self->_is_full('T')) {
3618        DB::print_trace( $OUT, 1 );    # skip DB
3619        next CMD;
3620    }
3621
3622    return;
3623}
3624
3625sub _handle_w_command {
3626    my $self = shift;
3627
3628    DB::cmd_w( 'w', $self->cmd_args() );
3629    next CMD;
3630
3631    return;
3632}
3633
3634sub _handle_W_command {
3635    my $self = shift;
3636
3637    if (my $arg = $self->cmd_args) {
3638        DB::cmd_W( 'W', $arg );
3639        next CMD;
3640    }
3641
3642    return;
3643}
3644
3645sub _handle_rc_recall_command {
3646    my $self = shift;
3647
3648    # $rc - recall command.
3649    if (my ($minus, $arg) = $DB::cmd =~ m#\A$rc+\s*(-)?(\d+)?\z#) {
3650
3651        # No arguments, take one thing off history.
3652        pop(@hist) if length($DB::cmd) > 1;
3653
3654        # Relative (- found)?
3655        #  Y - index back from most recent (by 1 if bare minus)
3656        #  N - go to that particular command slot or the last
3657        #      thing if nothing following.
3658
3659        $self->cmd_verb(
3660            scalar($minus ? ( $#hist - ( $arg || 1 ) ) : ( $arg || $#hist ))
3661        );
3662
3663        # Pick out the command desired.
3664        $DB::cmd = $hist[$self->cmd_verb];
3665
3666        # Print the command to be executed and restart the loop
3667        # with that command in the buffer.
3668        print {$OUT} $DB::cmd, "\n";
3669        redo CMD;
3670    }
3671
3672    return;
3673}
3674
3675sub _handle_rc_search_history_command {
3676    my $self = shift;
3677
3678    # $rc pattern $rc - find a command in the history.
3679    if (my ($arg) = $DB::cmd =~ /\A$rc([^$rc].*)\z/) {
3680
3681        # Create the pattern to use.
3682        my $pat = "^$arg";
3683        $self->pat($pat);
3684
3685        # Toss off last entry if length is >1 (and it always is).
3686        pop(@hist) if length($DB::cmd) > 1;
3687
3688        my $i;
3689
3690        # Look backward through the history.
3691        SEARCH_HIST:
3692        for ( $i = $#hist ; $i ; --$i ) {
3693            # Stop if we find it.
3694            last SEARCH_HIST if $hist[$i] =~ /$pat/;
3695        }
3696
3697        if ( !$i ) {
3698
3699            # Never found it.
3700            print $OUT "No such command!\n\n";
3701            next CMD;
3702        }
3703
3704        # Found it. Put it in the buffer, print it, and process it.
3705        $DB::cmd = $hist[$i];
3706        print $OUT $DB::cmd, "\n";
3707        redo CMD;
3708    }
3709
3710    return;
3711}
3712
3713sub _handle_H_command {
3714    my $self = shift;
3715
3716    if ($self->cmd_args =~ m#\A\*#) {
3717        @hist = @truehist = ();
3718        print $OUT "History cleansed\n";
3719        next CMD;
3720    }
3721
3722    if (my ($num) = $self->cmd_args =~ /\A(?:-(\d+))?/) {
3723
3724        # Anything other than negative numbers is ignored by
3725        # the (incorrect) pattern, so this test does nothing.
3726        $end = $num ? ( $#hist - $num ) : 0;
3727
3728        # Set to the minimum if less than zero.
3729        $hist = 0 if $hist < 0;
3730
3731        # Start at the end of the array.
3732        # Stay in while we're still above the ending value.
3733        # Tick back by one each time around the loop.
3734        my $i;
3735
3736        for ( $i = $#hist ; $i > $end ; $i-- ) {
3737
3738            # Print the command  unless it has no arguments.
3739            print $OUT "$i: ", $hist[$i], "\n"
3740            unless $hist[$i] =~ /^.?$/;
3741        }
3742
3743        next CMD;
3744    }
3745
3746    return;
3747}
3748
3749sub _handle_doc_command {
3750    my $self = shift;
3751
3752    # man, perldoc, doc - show manual pages.
3753    if (my ($man_page)
3754        = $DB::cmd =~ /\A(?:man|(?:perl)?doc)\b(?:\s+([^(]*))?\z/) {
3755        DB::runman($man_page);
3756        next CMD;
3757    }
3758
3759    return;
3760}
3761
3762sub _handle_p_command {
3763    my $self = shift;
3764
3765    my $print_cmd = 'print {$DB::OUT} ';
3766    # p - print (no args): print $_.
3767    if ($self->_is_full('p')) {
3768        $DB::cmd = $print_cmd . '$_';
3769    }
3770    else {
3771        # p - print the given expression.
3772        $DB::cmd =~ s/\Ap\b/$print_cmd /;
3773    }
3774
3775    return;
3776}
3777
3778sub _handle_equal_sign_command {
3779    my $self = shift;
3780
3781    if ($DB::cmd =~ s/\A=\s*//) {
3782        my @keys;
3783        if ( length $DB::cmd == 0 ) {
3784
3785            # No args, get current aliases.
3786            @keys = sort keys %alias;
3787        }
3788        elsif ( my ( $k, $v ) = ( $DB::cmd =~ /^(\S+)\s+(\S.*)/ ) ) {
3789
3790            # Creating a new alias. $k is alias name, $v is
3791            # alias value.
3792
3793            # can't use $_ or kill //g state
3794            for my $x ( $k, $v ) {
3795
3796                # Escape "alarm" characters.
3797                $x =~ s/\a/\\a/g;
3798            }
3799
3800            # Substitute key for value, using alarm chars
3801            # as separators (which is why we escaped them in
3802            # the command).
3803            $alias{$k} = "s\a$k\a$v\a";
3804
3805            # Turn off standard warn and die behavior.
3806            local $SIG{__DIE__};
3807            local $SIG{__WARN__};
3808
3809            # Is it valid Perl?
3810            unless ( eval "sub { s\a$k\a$v\a }; 1" ) {
3811
3812                # Nope. Bad alias. Say so and get out.
3813                print $OUT "Can't alias $k to $v: $@\n";
3814                delete $alias{$k};
3815                next CMD;
3816            }
3817
3818            # We'll only list the new one.
3819            @keys = ($k);
3820        } ## end elsif (my ($k, $v) = ($DB::cmd...
3821
3822        # The argument is the alias to list.
3823        else {
3824            @keys = ($DB::cmd);
3825        }
3826
3827        # List aliases.
3828        for my $k (@keys) {
3829
3830            # Messy metaquoting: Trim the substitution code off.
3831            # We use control-G as the delimiter because it's not
3832            # likely to appear in the alias.
3833            if ( ( my $v = $alias{$k} ) =~ ss\a$k\a(.*)\a$1 ) {
3834
3835                # Print the alias.
3836                print $OUT "$k\t= $1\n";
3837            }
3838            elsif ( defined $alias{$k} ) {
3839
3840                # Couldn't trim it off; just print the alias code.
3841                print $OUT "$k\t$alias{$k}\n";
3842            }
3843            else {
3844
3845                # No such, dude.
3846                print "No alias for $k\n";
3847            }
3848        } ## end for my $k (@keys)
3849        next CMD;
3850    }
3851
3852    return;
3853}
3854
3855sub _handle_source_command {
3856    my $self = shift;
3857
3858    # source - read commands from a file (or pipe!) and execute.
3859    if (my $sourced_fn = $self->cmd_args) {
3860        if ( open my $fh, $sourced_fn ) {
3861
3862            # Opened OK; stick it in the list of file handles.
3863            push @cmdfhs, $fh;
3864        }
3865        else {
3866
3867            # Couldn't open it.
3868            DB::_db_warn("Can't execute '$sourced_fn': $!\n");
3869        }
3870        next CMD;
3871    }
3872
3873    return;
3874}
3875
3876sub _handle_enable_disable_commands {
3877    my $self = shift;
3878
3879    my $which_cmd = $self->cmd_verb;
3880    my $position = $self->cmd_args;
3881
3882    if ($position !~ /\s/) {
3883        my ($fn, $line_num);
3884        if ($position =~ m{\A\d+\z})
3885        {
3886            $fn = $DB::filename;
3887            $line_num = $position;
3888        }
3889        elsif (my ($new_fn, $new_line_num)
3890            = $position =~ m{\A(.*):(\d+)\z}) {
3891            ($fn, $line_num) = ($new_fn, $new_line_num);
3892        }
3893        else
3894        {
3895            DB::_db_warn("Wrong spec for enable/disable argument.\n");
3896        }
3897
3898        if (defined($fn)) {
3899            if (DB::_has_breakpoint_data_ref($fn, $line_num)) {
3900                DB::_set_breakpoint_enabled_status($fn, $line_num,
3901                    ($which_cmd eq 'enable' ? 1 : '')
3902                );
3903            }
3904            else {
3905                DB::_db_warn("No breakpoint set at ${fn}:${line_num}\n");
3906            }
3907        }
3908
3909        next CMD;
3910    }
3911
3912    return;
3913}
3914
3915sub _handle_save_command {
3916    my $self = shift;
3917
3918    if (my $new_fn = $self->cmd_args) {
3919        my $filename = $new_fn || '.perl5dbrc';    # default?
3920        if ( open my $fh, '>', $filename ) {
3921
3922            # chomp to remove extraneous newlines from source'd files
3923            chomp( my @truelist =
3924                map { m/\A\s*(save|source)/ ? "#$_" : $_ }
3925                @truehist );
3926            print {$fh} join( "\n", @truelist );
3927            print "commands saved in $filename\n";
3928        }
3929        else {
3930            DB::_db_warn("Can't save debugger commands in '$new_fn': $!\n");
3931        }
3932        next CMD;
3933    }
3934
3935    return;
3936}
3937
3938sub _n_or_s_and_arg_commands_generic {
3939    my ($self, $letter, $new_val) = @_;
3940
3941    # s - single-step. Remember the last command was 's'.
3942    if ($DB::cmd =~ s#\A\Q$letter\E\s#\$DB::single = $new_val;\n#) {
3943        $laststep = $letter;
3944    }
3945
3946    return;
3947}
3948
3949sub _handle_sh_command {
3950    my $self = shift;
3951
3952    # $sh$sh - run a shell command (if it's all ASCII).
3953    # Can't run shell commands with Unicode in the debugger, hmm.
3954    my $my_cmd = $DB::cmd;
3955    if ($my_cmd =~ m#\A$sh#gms) {
3956
3957        if ($my_cmd =~ m#\G\z#cgms) {
3958            # Run the user's shell. If none defined, run Bourne.
3959            # We resume execution when the shell terminates.
3960            DB::_db_system( $ENV{SHELL} || "/bin/sh" );
3961            next CMD;
3962        }
3963        elsif ($my_cmd =~ m#\G$sh\s*(.*)#cgms) {
3964            # System it.
3965            DB::_db_system($1);
3966            next CMD;
3967        }
3968        elsif ($my_cmd =~ m#\G\s*(.*)#cgms) {
3969            DB::_db_system( $ENV{SHELL} || "/bin/sh", "-c", $1 );
3970            next CMD;
3971        }
3972    }
3973}
3974
3975sub _handle_x_command {
3976    my $self = shift;
3977
3978    if ($DB::cmd =~ s#\Ax\b# #) {    # Remainder gets done by DB::eval()
3979        $onetimeDump = 'dump';    # main::dumpvar shows the output
3980
3981        # handle special  "x 3 blah" syntax XXX propagate
3982        # doc back to special variables.
3983        if ( $DB::cmd =~ s#\A\s*(\d+)(?=\s)# #) {
3984            $onetimedumpDepth = $1;
3985        }
3986    }
3987
3988    return;
3989}
3990
3991sub _handle_q_command {
3992    my $self = shift;
3993
3994    if ($self->_is_full('q')) {
3995        $fall_off_end = 1;
3996        DB::clean_ENV();
3997        exit $?;
3998    }
3999
4000    return;
4001}
4002
4003sub _handle_cmd_wrapper_commands {
4004    my $self = shift;
4005
4006    DB::cmd_wrapper( $self->cmd_verb, $self->cmd_args, $line );
4007    next CMD;
4008}
4009
4010sub _handle_special_char_cmd_wrapper_commands {
4011    my $self = shift;
4012
4013    # All of these commands were remapped in perl 5.8.0;
4014    # we send them off to the secondary dispatcher (see below).
4015    if (my ($cmd_letter, $my_arg) = $DB::cmd =~ /\A([<>\{]{1,2})\s*(.*)/so) {
4016        DB::cmd_wrapper( $cmd_letter, $my_arg, $line );
4017        next CMD;
4018    }
4019
4020    return;
4021}
4022
4023} ## end DB::Obj
4024
4025package DB;
4026
4027# The following code may be executed now:
4028# BEGIN {warn 4}
4029
4030=head2 sub
4031
4032C<sub> is called whenever a subroutine call happens in the program being
4033debugged. The variable C<$DB::sub> contains the name of the subroutine
4034being called.
4035
4036The core function of this subroutine is to actually call the sub in the proper
4037context, capturing its output. This of course causes C<DB::DB> to get called
4038again, repeating until the subroutine ends and returns control to C<DB::sub>
4039again. Once control returns, C<DB::sub> figures out whether or not to dump the
4040return value, and returns its captured copy of the return value as its own
4041return value. The value then feeds back into the program being debugged as if
4042C<DB::sub> hadn't been there at all.
4043
4044C<sub> does all the work of printing the subroutine entry and exit messages
4045enabled by setting C<$frame>. It notes what sub the autoloader got called for,
4046and also prints the return value if needed (for the C<r> command and if
4047the 16 bit is set in C<$frame>).
4048
4049It also tracks the subroutine call depth by saving the current setting of
4050C<$single> in the C<@stack> package global; if this exceeds the value in
4051C<$deep>, C<sub> automatically turns on printing of the current depth by
4052setting the C<4> bit in C<$single>. In any case, it keeps the current setting
4053of stop/don't stop on entry to subs set as it currently is set.
4054
4055=head3 C<caller()> support
4056
4057If C<caller()> is called from the package C<DB>, it provides some
4058additional data, in the following order:
4059
4060=over 4
4061
4062=item * C<$package>
4063
4064The package name the sub was in
4065
4066=item * C<$filename>
4067
4068The filename it was defined in
4069
4070=item * C<$line>
4071
4072The line number it was defined on
4073
4074=item * C<$subroutine>
4075
4076The subroutine name; C<(eval)> if an C<eval>().
4077
4078=item * C<$hasargs>
4079
40801 if it has arguments, 0 if not
4081
4082=item * C<$wantarray>
4083
40841 if array context, 0 if scalar context
4085
4086=item * C<$evaltext>
4087
4088The C<eval>() text, if any (undefined for C<eval BLOCK>)
4089
4090=item * C<$is_require>
4091
4092frame was created by a C<use> or C<require> statement
4093
4094=item * C<$hints>
4095
4096pragma information; subject to change between versions
4097
4098=item * C<$bitmask>
4099
4100pragma information; subject to change between versions
4101
4102=item * C<@DB::args>
4103
4104arguments with which the subroutine was invoked
4105
4106=back
4107
4108=cut
4109
4110use vars qw($deep);
4111
4112# We need to fully qualify the name ("DB::sub") to make "use strict;"
4113# happy. -- Shlomi Fish
4114
4115sub _indent_print_line_info {
4116    my ($offset, $str) = @_;
4117
4118    print_lineinfo( ' ' x ($stack_depth - $offset), $str);
4119
4120    return;
4121}
4122
4123sub _print_frame_message {
4124    my ($al) = @_;
4125
4126    if ($frame) {
4127        if ($frame & 4) {   # Extended frame entry message
4128            _indent_print_line_info(-1, "in  ");
4129
4130            # Why -1? But it works! :-(
4131            # Because print_trace will call add 1 to it and then call
4132            # dump_trace; this results in our skipping -1+1 = 0 stack frames
4133            # in dump_trace.
4134            #
4135            # Now it's 0 because we extracted a function.
4136            print_trace( $LINEINFO, 0, 1, 1, "$sub$al" );
4137        }
4138        else {
4139            _indent_print_line_info(-1, "entering $sub$al\n" );
4140        }
4141    }
4142
4143    return;
4144}
4145
4146sub DB::sub {
4147    my ( $al, $ret, @ret ) = "";
4148
4149    # We stack the stack pointer and then increment it to protect us
4150    # from a situation that might unwind a whole bunch of call frames
4151    # at once. Localizing the stack pointer means that it will automatically
4152    # unwind the same amount when multiple stack frames are unwound.
4153    local $stack_depth = $stack_depth + 1;    # Protect from non-local exits
4154
4155    {
4156        # lock ourselves under threads
4157        # While lock() permits recursive locks, there's two cases where it's bad
4158        # that we keep a hold on the lock while we call the sub:
4159        #  - during cloning, Package::CLONE might be called in the context of the new
4160        #    thread, which will deadlock if we hold the lock across the threads::new call
4161        #  - for any function that waits any significant time
4162        # This also deadlocks if the parent thread joins(), since holding the lock
4163        # will prevent any child threads passing this point.
4164        # So release the lock for the function call.
4165        lock($DBGR);
4166
4167        # Whether or not the autoloader was running, a scalar to put the
4168        # sub's return value in (if needed), and an array to put the sub's
4169        # return value in (if needed).
4170        if ($sub eq 'threads::new' && $ENV{PERL5DB_THREADED}) {
4171            print "creating new thread\n";
4172        }
4173
4174        # If the last ten characters are '::AUTOLOAD', note we've traced
4175        # into AUTOLOAD for $sub.
4176        if ( length($sub) > 10 && substr( $sub, -10, 10 ) eq '::AUTOLOAD' ) {
4177            no strict 'refs';
4178            $al = " for $$sub" if defined $$sub;
4179        }
4180
4181        # Expand @stack.
4182        $#stack = $stack_depth;
4183
4184        # Save current single-step setting.
4185        $stack[-1] = $single;
4186
4187        # Turn off all flags except single-stepping.
4188        $single &= 1;
4189
4190        # If we've gotten really deeply recursed, turn on the flag that will
4191        # make us stop with the 'deep recursion' message.
4192        $single |= 4 if $stack_depth == $deep;
4193
4194        # If frame messages are on ...
4195
4196        _print_frame_message($al);
4197    }
4198
4199    # Determine the sub's return type, and capture appropriately.
4200    if (wantarray) {
4201
4202        # Called in array context. call sub and capture output.
4203        # DB::DB will recursively get control again if appropriate; we'll come
4204        # back here when the sub is finished.
4205        no strict 'refs';
4206        @ret = &$sub;
4207    }
4208    elsif ( defined wantarray ) {
4209        no strict 'refs';
4210        # Save the value if it's wanted at all.
4211        $ret = &$sub;
4212    }
4213    else {
4214        no strict 'refs';
4215        # Void return, explicitly.
4216        &$sub;
4217        undef $ret;
4218    }
4219
4220    {
4221        lock($DBGR);
4222
4223        # Pop the single-step value back off the stack.
4224        $single |= $stack[ $stack_depth-- ];
4225
4226        if ($frame & 2) {
4227            if ($frame & 4) {   # Extended exit message
4228                _indent_print_line_info(0, "out ");
4229                print_trace( $LINEINFO, -1, 1, 1, "$sub$al" );
4230            }
4231            else {
4232                _indent_print_line_info(0, "exited $sub$al\n" );
4233            }
4234        }
4235
4236        if (wantarray) {
4237            # Print the return info if we need to.
4238            if ( $doret eq $stack_depth or $frame & 16 ) {
4239
4240                # Turn off output record separator.
4241                local $\ = '';
4242                my $fh = ( $doret eq $stack_depth ? $OUT : $LINEINFO );
4243
4244                # Indent if we're printing because of $frame tracing.
4245                if ($frame & 16)
4246                  {
4247                      print {$fh} ' ' x $stack_depth;
4248                  }
4249
4250                # Print the return value.
4251                print {$fh} "list context return from $sub:\n";
4252                dumpit( $fh, \@ret );
4253
4254                # And don't print it again.
4255                $doret = -2;
4256            } ## end if ($doret eq $stack_depth...
4257            # And we have to return the return value now.
4258            @ret;
4259        } ## end if (wantarray)
4260        # Scalar context.
4261        else {
4262            # If we are supposed to show the return value... same as before.
4263            if ( $doret eq $stack_depth or $frame & 16 and defined wantarray ) {
4264                local $\ = '';
4265                my $fh = ( $doret eq $stack_depth ? $OUT : $LINEINFO );
4266                print $fh ( ' ' x $stack_depth ) if $frame & 16;
4267                print $fh (
4268                           defined wantarray
4269                           ? "scalar context return from $sub: "
4270                           : "void context return from $sub\n"
4271                          );
4272                dumpit( $fh, $ret ) if defined wantarray;
4273                $doret = -2;
4274            } ## end if ($doret eq $stack_depth...
4275
4276            # Return the appropriate scalar value.
4277            $ret;
4278        } ## end else [ if (wantarray)
4279    }
4280} ## end sub _sub
4281
4282sub lsub : lvalue {
4283
4284    # We stack the stack pointer and then increment it to protect us
4285    # from a situation that might unwind a whole bunch of call frames
4286    # at once. Localizing the stack pointer means that it will automatically
4287    # unwind the same amount when multiple stack frames are unwound.
4288    local $stack_depth = $stack_depth + 1;    # Protect from non-local exits
4289
4290    # Expand @stack.
4291    $#stack = $stack_depth;
4292
4293    # Save current single-step setting.
4294    $stack[-1] = $single;
4295
4296    # Turn off all flags except single-stepping.
4297    # Use local so the single-step value is popped back off the
4298    # stack for us.
4299    local $single = $single & 1;
4300
4301    no strict 'refs';
4302    {
4303        # lock ourselves under threads
4304        lock($DBGR);
4305
4306        # Whether or not the autoloader was running, a scalar to put the
4307        # sub's return value in (if needed), and an array to put the sub's
4308        # return value in (if needed).
4309        my ( $al, $ret, @ret ) = "";
4310        if ($sub =~ /^threads::new$/ && $ENV{PERL5DB_THREADED}) {
4311            print "creating new thread\n";
4312        }
4313
4314        # If the last ten characters are C'::AUTOLOAD', note we've traced
4315        # into AUTOLOAD for $sub.
4316        if ( length($sub) > 10 && substr( $sub, -10, 10 ) eq '::AUTOLOAD' ) {
4317            $al = " for $$sub";
4318        }
4319
4320        # If we've gotten really deeply recursed, turn on the flag that will
4321        # make us stop with the 'deep recursion' message.
4322        $single |= 4 if $stack_depth == $deep;
4323
4324        # If frame messages are on ...
4325        _print_frame_message($al);
4326    }
4327
4328    # call the original lvalue sub.
4329    &$sub;
4330}
4331
4332# Abstracting common code from multiple places elsewhere:
4333sub depth_print_lineinfo {
4334    my $always_print = shift;
4335
4336    print_lineinfo( @_ ) if ($always_print or $stack_depth < $trace_to_depth);
4337}
4338
4339=head1 EXTENDED COMMAND HANDLING AND THE COMMAND API
4340
4341In Perl 5.8.0, there was a major realignment of the commands and what they did,
4342Most of the changes were to systematize the command structure and to eliminate
4343commands that threw away user input without checking.
4344
4345The following sections describe the code added to make it easy to support
4346multiple command sets with conflicting command names. This section is a start
4347at unifying all command processing to make it simpler to develop commands.
4348
4349Note that all the cmd_[a-zA-Z] subroutines require the command name, a line
4350number, and C<$dbline> (the current line) as arguments.
4351
4352Support functions in this section which have multiple modes of failure C<die>
4353on error; the rest simply return a false value.
4354
4355The user-interface functions (all of the C<cmd_*> functions) just output
4356error messages.
4357
4358=head2 C<%set>
4359
4360The C<%set> hash defines the mapping from command letter to subroutine
4361name suffix.
4362
4363C<%set> is a two-level hash, indexed by set name and then by command name.
4364Note that trying to set the CommandSet to C<foobar> simply results in the
43655.8.0 command set being used, since there's no top-level entry for C<foobar>.
4366
4367=cut
4368
4369### The API section
4370
4371my %set = (    #
4372    'pre580' => {
4373        'a' => 'pre580_a',
4374        'A' => 'pre580_null',
4375        'b' => 'pre580_b',
4376        'B' => 'pre580_null',
4377        'd' => 'pre580_null',
4378        'D' => 'pre580_D',
4379        'h' => 'pre580_h',
4380        'M' => 'pre580_null',
4381        'O' => 'o',
4382        'o' => 'pre580_null',
4383        'v' => 'M',
4384        'w' => 'v',
4385        'W' => 'pre580_W',
4386    },
4387    'pre590' => {
4388        '<'  => 'pre590_prepost',
4389        '<<' => 'pre590_prepost',
4390        '>'  => 'pre590_prepost',
4391        '>>' => 'pre590_prepost',
4392        '{'  => 'pre590_prepost',
4393        '{{' => 'pre590_prepost',
4394    },
4395);
4396
4397my %breakpoints_data;
4398
4399sub _has_breakpoint_data_ref {
4400    my ($filename, $line) = @_;
4401
4402    return (
4403        exists( $breakpoints_data{$filename} )
4404            and
4405        exists( $breakpoints_data{$filename}{$line} )
4406    );
4407}
4408
4409sub _get_breakpoint_data_ref {
4410    my ($filename, $line) = @_;
4411
4412    return ($breakpoints_data{$filename}{$line} ||= +{});
4413}
4414
4415sub _delete_breakpoint_data_ref {
4416    my ($filename, $line) = @_;
4417
4418    delete($breakpoints_data{$filename}{$line});
4419    if (! scalar(keys( %{$breakpoints_data{$filename}} )) ) {
4420        delete($breakpoints_data{$filename});
4421    }
4422
4423    return;
4424}
4425
4426sub _set_breakpoint_enabled_status {
4427    my ($filename, $line, $status) = @_;
4428
4429    _get_breakpoint_data_ref($filename, $line)->{'enabled'} =
4430        ($status ? 1 : '')
4431        ;
4432
4433    return;
4434}
4435
4436sub _enable_breakpoint_temp_enabled_status {
4437    my ($filename, $line) = @_;
4438
4439    _get_breakpoint_data_ref($filename, $line)->{'temp_enabled'} = 1;
4440
4441    return;
4442}
4443
4444sub _cancel_breakpoint_temp_enabled_status {
4445    my ($filename, $line) = @_;
4446
4447    my $ref = _get_breakpoint_data_ref($filename, $line);
4448
4449    delete ($ref->{'temp_enabled'});
4450
4451    if (! %$ref) {
4452        _delete_breakpoint_data_ref($filename, $line);
4453    }
4454
4455    return;
4456}
4457
4458sub _is_breakpoint_enabled {
4459    my ($filename, $line) = @_;
4460
4461    my $data_ref = _get_breakpoint_data_ref($filename, $line);
4462    return ($data_ref->{'enabled'} || $data_ref->{'temp_enabled'});
4463}
4464
4465=head2 C<cmd_wrapper()> (API)
4466
4467C<cmd_wrapper()> allows the debugger to switch command sets
4468depending on the value of the C<CommandSet> option.
4469
4470It tries to look up the command in the C<%set> package-level I<lexical>
4471(which means external entities can't fiddle with it) and create the name of
4472the sub to call based on the value found in the hash (if it's there). I<All>
4473of the commands to be handled in a set have to be added to C<%set>; if they
4474aren't found, the 5.8.0 equivalent is called (if there is one).
4475
4476This code uses symbolic references.
4477
4478=cut
4479
4480sub cmd_wrapper {
4481    my $cmd      = shift;
4482    my $line     = shift;
4483    my $dblineno = shift;
4484
4485    # Assemble the command subroutine's name by looking up the
4486    # command set and command name in %set. If we can't find it,
4487    # default to the older version of the command.
4488    my $call = 'cmd_'
4489      . ( $set{$CommandSet}{$cmd}
4490          || ( $cmd =~ /\A[<>{]+/o ? 'prepost' : $cmd ) );
4491
4492    # Call the command subroutine, call it by name.
4493    return __PACKAGE__->can($call)->( $cmd, $line, $dblineno );
4494} ## end sub cmd_wrapper
4495
4496=head3 C<cmd_a> (command)
4497
4498The C<a> command handles pre-execution actions. These are associated with a
4499particular line, so they're stored in C<%dbline>. We default to the current
4500line if none is specified.
4501
4502=cut
4503
4504sub cmd_a {
4505    my $cmd    = shift;
4506    my $line   = shift || '';    # [.|line] expr
4507    my $dbline = shift;
4508
4509    # If it's dot (here), or not all digits,  use the current line.
4510    $line =~ s/\A\./$dbline/;
4511
4512    # Should be a line number followed by an expression.
4513    if ( my ($lineno, $expr) = $line =~ /^\s*(\d*)\s*(\S.+)/ ) {
4514
4515        if (! length($lineno)) {
4516            $lineno = $dbline;
4517        }
4518
4519        # If we have an expression ...
4520        if ( length $expr ) {
4521
4522            # ... but the line isn't breakable, complain.
4523            if ( $dbline[$lineno] == 0 ) {
4524                print $OUT
4525                  "Line $lineno($dbline[$lineno]) does not have an action?\n";
4526            }
4527            else {
4528
4529                # It's executable. Record that the line has an action.
4530                $had_breakpoints{$filename} |= 2;
4531
4532                # Remove any action, temp breakpoint, etc.
4533                $dbline{$lineno} =~ s/\0[^\0]*//;
4534
4535                # Add the action to the line.
4536                $dbline{$lineno} .= "\0" . action($expr);
4537
4538                _set_breakpoint_enabled_status($filename, $lineno, 1);
4539            }
4540        } ## end if (length $expr)
4541    } ## end if ($line =~ /^\s*(\d*)\s*(\S.+)/)
4542    else {
4543
4544        # Syntax wrong.
4545        print $OUT
4546          "Adding an action requires an optional lineno and an expression\n"
4547          ;    # hint
4548    }
4549} ## end sub cmd_a
4550
4551=head3 C<cmd_A> (command)
4552
4553Delete actions. Similar to above, except the delete code is in a separate
4554subroutine, C<delete_action>.
4555
4556=cut
4557
4558sub cmd_A {
4559    my $cmd    = shift;
4560    my $line   = shift || '';
4561    my $dbline = shift;
4562
4563    # Dot is this line.
4564    $line =~ s/^\./$dbline/;
4565
4566    # Call delete_action with a null param to delete them all.
4567    # The '1' forces the eval to be true. It'll be false only
4568    # if delete_action blows up for some reason, in which case
4569    # we print $@ and get out.
4570    if ( $line eq '*' ) {
4571        if (! eval { _delete_all_actions(); 1 }) {
4572            print {$OUT} $@;
4573            return;
4574        }
4575    }
4576
4577    # There's a real line  number. Pass it to delete_action.
4578    # Error trapping is as above.
4579    elsif ( $line =~ /^(\S.*)/ ) {
4580        if (! eval { delete_action($1); 1 }) {
4581            print {$OUT} $@;
4582            return;
4583        }
4584    }
4585
4586    # Swing and a miss. Bad syntax.
4587    else {
4588        print $OUT
4589          "Deleting an action requires a line number, or '*' for all\n" ; # hint
4590    }
4591} ## end sub cmd_A
4592
4593=head3 C<delete_action> (API)
4594
4595C<delete_action> accepts either a line number or C<undef>. If a line number
4596is specified, we check for the line being executable (if it's not, it
4597couldn't have had an  action). If it is, we just take the action off (this
4598will get any kind of an action, including breakpoints).
4599
4600=cut
4601
4602sub _remove_action_from_dbline {
4603    my $i = shift;
4604
4605    $dbline{$i} =~ s/\0[^\0]*//;    # \^a
4606    delete $dbline{$i} if $dbline{$i} eq '';
4607
4608    return;
4609}
4610
4611sub _delete_all_actions {
4612    print {$OUT} "Deleting all actions...\n";
4613
4614    for my $file ( keys %had_breakpoints ) {
4615        local *dbline = $main::{ '_<' . $file };
4616        $max = $#dbline;
4617        my $was;
4618        for my $i (1 .. $max) {
4619            if ( defined $dbline{$i} ) {
4620                _remove_action_from_dbline($i);
4621            }
4622        }
4623
4624        unless ( $had_breakpoints{$file} &= ~2 ) {
4625            delete $had_breakpoints{$file};
4626        }
4627    }
4628
4629    return;
4630}
4631
4632sub delete_action {
4633    my $i = shift;
4634
4635    if ( defined($i) ) {
4636        # Can there be one?
4637        die "Line $i has no action .\n" if $dbline[$i] == 0;
4638
4639        # Nuke whatever's there.
4640        _remove_action_from_dbline($i);
4641    }
4642    else {
4643        _delete_all_actions();
4644    }
4645}
4646
4647=head3 C<cmd_b> (command)
4648
4649Set breakpoints. Since breakpoints can be set in so many places, in so many
4650ways, conditionally or not, the breakpoint code is kind of complex. Mostly,
4651we try to parse the command type, and then shuttle it off to an appropriate
4652subroutine to actually do the work of setting the breakpoint in the right
4653place.
4654
4655=cut
4656
4657sub cmd_b {
4658    my $cmd    = shift;
4659    my $line   = shift;    # [.|line] [cond]
4660    my $dbline = shift;
4661
4662    my $default_cond = sub {
4663        my $cond = shift;
4664        return length($cond) ? $cond : '1';
4665    };
4666
4667    # Make . the current line number if it's there..
4668    $line =~ s/^\.(\s|\z)/$dbline$1/;
4669
4670    # No line number, no condition. Simple break on current line.
4671    if ( $line =~ /^\s*$/ ) {
4672        cmd_b_line( $dbline, 1 );
4673    }
4674
4675    # Break on load for a file.
4676    elsif ( my ($file) = $line =~ /^load\b\s*(.*)/ ) {
4677        $file =~ s/\s+\z//;
4678        cmd_b_load($file);
4679    }
4680
4681    # b compile|postpone <some sub> [<condition>]
4682    # The interpreter actually traps this one for us; we just put the
4683    # necessary condition in the %postponed hash.
4684    elsif ( my ($action, $subname, $cond)
4685        = $line =~ /^(postpone|compile)\b\s*([':A-Za-z_][':\w]*)\s*(.*)/ ) {
4686
4687        # De-Perl4-ify the name - ' separators to ::.
4688        $subname =~ s/'/::/g;
4689
4690        # Qualify it into the current package unless it's already qualified.
4691        $subname = "${package}::" . $subname unless $subname =~ /::/;
4692
4693        # Add main if it starts with ::.
4694        $subname = "main" . $subname if substr( $subname, 0, 2 ) eq "::";
4695
4696        # Save the break type for this sub.
4697        $postponed{$subname} = (($action eq 'postpone')
4698            ? ( "break +0 if " . $default_cond->($cond) )
4699            : "compile");
4700    } ## end elsif ($line =~ ...
4701    # b <filename>:<line> [<condition>]
4702    elsif (my ($filename, $line_num, $cond)
4703        = $line =~ /\A(\S+[^:]):(\d+)\s*(.*)/ms) {
4704        cmd_b_filename_line(
4705            $filename,
4706            $line_num,
4707            (length($cond) ? $cond : '1'),
4708        );
4709    }
4710    # b <sub name> [<condition>]
4711    elsif ( my ($new_subname, $new_cond) =
4712        $line =~ /^([':A-Za-z_][':\w]*(?:\[.*\])?)\s*(.*)/ ) {
4713
4714        #
4715        $subname = $new_subname;
4716        cmd_b_sub( $subname, $default_cond->($new_cond) );
4717    }
4718
4719    # b <line> [<condition>].
4720    elsif ( my ($line_n, $cond) = $line =~ /^(\d*)\s*(.*)/ ) {
4721
4722        # Capture the line. If none, it's the current line.
4723        $line = $line_n || $dbline;
4724
4725        # Break on line.
4726        cmd_b_line( $line, $default_cond->($cond) );
4727    }
4728
4729    # Line didn't make sense.
4730    else {
4731        print "confused by line($line)?\n";
4732    }
4733
4734    return;
4735} ## end sub cmd_b
4736
4737=head3 C<break_on_load> (API)
4738
4739We want to break when this file is loaded. Mark this file in the
4740C<%break_on_load> hash, and note that it has a breakpoint in
4741C<%had_breakpoints>.
4742
4743=cut
4744
4745sub break_on_load {
4746    my $file = shift;
4747    $break_on_load{$file} = 1;
4748    $had_breakpoints{$file} |= 1;
4749}
4750
4751=head3 C<report_break_on_load> (API)
4752
4753Gives us an array of filenames that are set to break on load. Note that
4754only files with break-on-load are in here, so simply showing the keys
4755suffices.
4756
4757=cut
4758
4759sub report_break_on_load {
4760    sort keys %break_on_load;
4761}
4762
4763=head3 C<cmd_b_load> (command)
4764
4765We take the file passed in and try to find it in C<%INC> (which maps modules
4766to files they came from). We mark those files for break-on-load via
4767C<break_on_load> and then report that it was done.
4768
4769=cut
4770
4771sub cmd_b_load {
4772    my $file = shift;
4773    my @files;
4774
4775    # This is a block because that way we can use a redo inside it
4776    # even without there being any looping structure at all outside it.
4777    {
4778
4779        # Save short name and full path if found.
4780        push @files, $file;
4781        push @files, $::INC{$file} if $::INC{$file};
4782
4783        # Tack on .pm and do it again unless there was a '.' in the name
4784        # already.
4785        $file .= '.pm', redo unless $file =~ /\./;
4786    }
4787
4788    # Do the real work here.
4789    break_on_load($_) for @files;
4790
4791    # All the files that have break-on-load breakpoints.
4792    @files = report_break_on_load;
4793
4794    # Normalize for the purposes of our printing this.
4795    local $\ = '';
4796    local $" = ' ';
4797    print $OUT "Will stop on load of '@files'.\n";
4798} ## end sub cmd_b_load
4799
4800=head3 C<$filename_error> (API package global)
4801
4802Several of the functions we need to implement in the API need to work both
4803on the current file and on other files. We don't want to duplicate code, so
4804C<$filename_error> is used to contain the name of the file that's being
4805worked on (if it's not the current one).
4806
4807We can now build functions in pairs: the basic function works on the current
4808file, and uses C<$filename_error> as part of its error message. Since this is
4809initialized to C<"">, no filename will appear when we are working on the
4810current file.
4811
4812The second function is a wrapper which does the following:
4813
4814=over 4
4815
4816=item *
4817
4818Localizes C<$filename_error> and sets it to the name of the file to be processed.
4819
4820=item *
4821
4822Localizes the C<*dbline> glob and reassigns it to point to the file we want to process.
4823
4824=item *
4825
4826Calls the first function.
4827
4828The first function works on the I<current> file (i.e., the one we changed to),
4829and prints C<$filename_error> in the error message (the name of the other file)
4830if it needs to. When the functions return, C<*dbline> is restored to point
4831to the actual current file (the one we're executing in) and
4832C<$filename_error> is restored to C<"">. This restores everything to
4833the way it was before the second function was called at all.
4834
4835See the comments in C<breakable_line> and C<breakable_line_in_file> for more
4836details.
4837
4838=back
4839
4840=cut
4841
4842use vars qw($filename_error);
4843$filename_error = '';
4844
4845=head3 breakable_line(from, to) (API)
4846
4847The subroutine decides whether or not a line in the current file is breakable.
4848It walks through C<@dbline> within the range of lines specified, looking for
4849the first line that is breakable.
4850
4851If C<$to> is greater than C<$from>, the search moves forwards, finding the
4852first line I<after> C<$to> that's breakable, if there is one.
4853
4854If C<$from> is greater than C<$to>, the search goes I<backwards>, finding the
4855first line I<before> C<$to> that's breakable, if there is one.
4856
4857=cut
4858
4859sub breakable_line {
4860
4861    my ( $from, $to ) = @_;
4862
4863    # $i is the start point. (Where are the FORTRAN programs of yesteryear?)
4864    my $i = $from;
4865
4866    # If there are at least 2 arguments, we're trying to search a range.
4867    if ( @_ >= 2 ) {
4868
4869        # $delta is positive for a forward search, negative for a backward one.
4870        my $delta = $from < $to ? +1 : -1;
4871
4872        # Keep us from running off the ends of the file.
4873        my $limit = $delta > 0 ? $#dbline : 1;
4874
4875        # Clever test. If you're a mathematician, it's obvious why this
4876        # test works. If not:
4877        # If $delta is positive (going forward), $limit will be $#dbline.
4878        #    If $to is less than $limit, ($limit - $to) will be positive, times
4879        #    $delta of 1 (positive), so the result is > 0 and we should use $to
4880        #    as the stopping point.
4881        #
4882        #    If $to is greater than $limit, ($limit - $to) is negative,
4883        #    times $delta of 1 (positive), so the result is < 0 and we should
4884        #    use $limit ($#dbline) as the stopping point.
4885        #
4886        # If $delta is negative (going backward), $limit will be 1.
4887        #    If $to is zero, ($limit - $to) will be 1, times $delta of -1
4888        #    (negative) so the result is > 0, and we use $to as the stopping
4889        #    point.
4890        #
4891        #    If $to is less than zero, ($limit - $to) will be positive,
4892        #    times $delta of -1 (negative), so the result is not > 0, and
4893        #    we use $limit (1) as the stopping point.
4894        #
4895        #    If $to is 1, ($limit - $to) will zero, times $delta of -1
4896        #    (negative), still giving zero; the result is not > 0, and
4897        #    we use $limit (1) as the stopping point.
4898        #
4899        #    if $to is >1, ($limit - $to) will be negative, times $delta of -1
4900        #    (negative), giving a positive (>0) value, so we'll set $limit to
4901        #    $to.
4902
4903        $limit = $to if ( $limit - $to ) * $delta > 0;
4904
4905        # The real search loop.
4906        # $i starts at $from (the point we want to start searching from).
4907        # We move through @dbline in the appropriate direction (determined
4908        # by $delta: either -1 (back) or +1 (ahead).
4909        # We stay in as long as we haven't hit an executable line
4910        # ($dbline[$i] == 0 means not executable) and we haven't reached
4911        # the limit yet (test similar to the above).
4912        $i += $delta while $dbline[$i] == 0 and ( $limit - $i ) * $delta > 0;
4913
4914    } ## end if (@_ >= 2)
4915
4916    # If $i points to a line that is executable, return that.
4917    return $i unless $dbline[$i] == 0;
4918
4919    # Format the message and print it: no breakable lines in range.
4920    my ( $pl, $upto ) = ( '', '' );
4921    ( $pl, $upto ) = ( 's', "..$to" ) if @_ >= 2 and $from != $to;
4922
4923    # If there's a filename in filename_error, we'll see it.
4924    # If not, not.
4925    die "Line$pl $from$upto$filename_error not breakable\n";
4926} ## end sub breakable_line
4927
4928=head3 breakable_line_in_filename(file, from, to) (API)
4929
4930Like C<breakable_line>, but look in another file.
4931
4932=cut
4933
4934sub breakable_line_in_filename {
4935
4936    # Capture the file name.
4937    my ($f) = shift;
4938
4939    # Swap the magic line array over there temporarily.
4940    local *dbline = $main::{ '_<' . $f };
4941
4942    # If there's an error, it's in this other file.
4943    local $filename_error = " of '$f'";
4944
4945    # Find the breakable line.
4946    breakable_line(@_);
4947
4948    # *dbline and $filename_error get restored when this block ends.
4949
4950} ## end sub breakable_line_in_filename
4951
4952=head3 break_on_line(lineno, [condition]) (API)
4953
4954Adds a breakpoint with the specified condition (or 1 if no condition was
4955specified) to the specified line. Dies if it can't.
4956
4957=cut
4958
4959sub break_on_line {
4960    my $i = shift;
4961    my $cond = @_ ? shift(@_) : 1;
4962
4963    my $inii  = $i;
4964    my $after = '';
4965    my $pl    = '';
4966
4967    # Woops, not a breakable line. $filename_error allows us to say
4968    # if it was in a different file.
4969    die "Line $i$filename_error not breakable.\n" if $dbline[$i] == 0;
4970
4971    # Mark this file as having breakpoints in it.
4972    $had_breakpoints{$filename} |= 1;
4973
4974    # If there is an action or condition here already ...
4975    if ( $dbline{$i} ) {
4976
4977        # ... swap this condition for the existing one.
4978        $dbline{$i} =~ s/^[^\0]*/$cond/;
4979    }
4980    else {
4981
4982        # Nothing here - just add the condition.
4983        $dbline{$i} = $cond;
4984
4985        _set_breakpoint_enabled_status($filename, $i, 1);
4986    }
4987
4988    return;
4989} ## end sub break_on_line
4990
4991=head3 cmd_b_line(line, [condition]) (command)
4992
4993Wrapper for C<break_on_line>. Prints the failure message if it
4994doesn't work.
4995
4996=cut
4997
4998sub cmd_b_line {
4999    if (not eval { break_on_line(@_); 1 }) {
5000        local $\ = '';
5001        print $OUT $@ and return;
5002    }
5003
5004    return;
5005} ## end sub cmd_b_line
5006
5007=head3 cmd_b_filename_line(line, [condition]) (command)
5008
5009Wrapper for C<break_on_filename_line>. Prints the failure message if it
5010doesn't work.
5011
5012=cut
5013
5014sub cmd_b_filename_line {
5015    if (not eval { break_on_filename_line(@_); 1 }) {
5016        local $\ = '';
5017        print $OUT $@ and return;
5018    }
5019
5020    return;
5021}
5022
5023=head3 break_on_filename_line(file, line, [condition]) (API)
5024
5025Switches to the file specified and then calls C<break_on_line> to set
5026the breakpoint.
5027
5028=cut
5029
5030sub break_on_filename_line {
5031    my $f = shift;
5032    my $i = shift;
5033    my $cond = @_ ? shift(@_) : 1;
5034
5035    # Switch the magical hash temporarily.
5036    local *dbline = $main::{ '_<' . $f };
5037
5038    # Localize the variables that break_on_line uses to make its message.
5039    local $filename_error = " of '$f'";
5040    local $filename       = $f;
5041
5042    # Add the breakpoint.
5043    break_on_line( $i, $cond );
5044
5045    return;
5046} ## end sub break_on_filename_line
5047
5048=head3 break_on_filename_line_range(file, from, to, [condition]) (API)
5049
5050Switch to another file, search the range of lines specified for an
5051executable one, and put a breakpoint on the first one you find.
5052
5053=cut
5054
5055sub break_on_filename_line_range {
5056    my $f = shift;
5057    my $from = shift;
5058    my $to = shift;
5059    my $cond = @_ ? shift(@_) : 1;
5060
5061    # Find a breakable line if there is one.
5062    my $i = breakable_line_in_filename( $f, $from, $to );
5063
5064    # Add the breakpoint.
5065    break_on_filename_line( $f, $i, $cond );
5066
5067    return;
5068} ## end sub break_on_filename_line_range
5069
5070=head3 subroutine_filename_lines(subname, [condition]) (API)
5071
5072Search for a subroutine within a given file. The condition is ignored.
5073Uses C<find_sub> to locate the desired subroutine.
5074
5075=cut
5076
5077sub subroutine_filename_lines {
5078    my ( $subname ) = @_;
5079
5080    # Returned value from find_sub() is fullpathname:startline-endline.
5081    # The match creates the list (fullpathname, start, end).
5082    return (find_sub($subname) =~ /^(.*):(\d+)-(\d+)$/);
5083} ## end sub subroutine_filename_lines
5084
5085=head3 break_subroutine(subname) (API)
5086
5087Places a break on the first line possible in the specified subroutine. Uses
5088C<subroutine_filename_lines> to find the subroutine, and
5089C<break_on_filename_line_range> to place the break.
5090
5091=cut
5092
5093sub break_subroutine {
5094    my $subname = shift;
5095
5096    # Get filename, start, and end.
5097    my ( $file, $s, $e ) = subroutine_filename_lines($subname)
5098      or die "Subroutine $subname not found.\n";
5099
5100
5101    # Null condition changes to '1' (always true).
5102    my $cond = @_ ? shift(@_) : 1;
5103
5104    # Put a break the first place possible in the range of lines
5105    # that make up this subroutine.
5106    break_on_filename_line_range( $file, $s, $e, $cond );
5107
5108    return;
5109} ## end sub break_subroutine
5110
5111=head3 cmd_b_sub(subname, [condition]) (command)
5112
5113We take the incoming subroutine name and fully-qualify it as best we can.
5114
5115=over 4
5116
5117=item 1. If it's already fully-qualified, leave it alone.
5118
5119=item 2. Try putting it in the current package.
5120
5121=item 3. If it's not there, try putting it in CORE::GLOBAL if it exists there.
5122
5123=item 4. If it starts with '::', put it in 'main::'.
5124
5125=back
5126
5127After all this cleanup, we call C<break_subroutine> to try to set the
5128breakpoint.
5129
5130=cut
5131
5132sub cmd_b_sub {
5133    my $subname = shift;
5134    my $cond = @_ ? shift : 1;
5135
5136    # If the subname isn't a code reference, qualify it so that
5137    # break_subroutine() will work right.
5138    if ( ref($subname) ne 'CODE' ) {
5139
5140        # Not Perl 4.
5141        $subname =~ s/'/::/g;
5142        my $s = $subname;
5143
5144        # Put it in this package unless it's already qualified.
5145        if ($subname !~ /::/)
5146        {
5147            $subname = $package . '::' . $subname;
5148        };
5149
5150        # Requalify it into CORE::GLOBAL if qualifying it into this
5151        # package resulted in its not being defined, but only do so
5152        # if it really is in CORE::GLOBAL.
5153        my $core_name = "CORE::GLOBAL::$s";
5154        if ((!defined(&$subname))
5155                and ($s !~ /::/)
5156                and (defined &{$core_name}))
5157        {
5158            $subname = $core_name;
5159        }
5160
5161        # Put it in package 'main' if it has a leading ::.
5162        if ($subname =~ /\A::/)
5163        {
5164            $subname = "main" . $subname;
5165        }
5166    } ## end if ( ref($subname) ne 'CODE' ) {
5167
5168    # Try to set the breakpoint.
5169    if (not eval { break_subroutine( $subname, $cond ); 1 }) {
5170        local $\ = '';
5171        print {$OUT} $@;
5172        return;
5173    }
5174
5175    return;
5176} ## end sub cmd_b_sub
5177
5178=head3 C<cmd_B> - delete breakpoint(s) (command)
5179
5180The command mostly parses the command line and tries to turn the argument
5181into a line spec. If it can't, it uses the current line. It then calls
5182C<delete_breakpoint> to actually do the work.
5183
5184If C<*> is  specified, C<cmd_B> calls C<delete_breakpoint> with no arguments,
5185thereby deleting all the breakpoints.
5186
5187=cut
5188
5189sub cmd_B {
5190    my $cmd = shift;
5191
5192    # No line spec? Use dbline.
5193    # If there is one, use it if it's non-zero, or wipe it out if it is.
5194    my $line   = ( $_[0] =~ /\A\./ ) ? $dbline : (shift || '');
5195    my $dbline = shift;
5196
5197    # If the line was dot, make the line the current one.
5198    $line =~ s/^\./$dbline/;
5199
5200    # If it's * we're deleting all the breakpoints.
5201    if ( $line eq '*' ) {
5202        if (not eval { delete_breakpoint(); 1 }) {
5203            print {$OUT} $@;
5204        }
5205    }
5206
5207    # If there is a line spec, delete the breakpoint on that line.
5208    elsif ( $line =~ /\A(\S.*)/ ) {
5209        if (not eval { delete_breakpoint( $line || $dbline ); 1 }) {
5210            local $\ = '';
5211            print {$OUT} $@;
5212        }
5213    } ## end elsif ($line =~ /^(\S.*)/)
5214
5215    # No line spec.
5216    else {
5217        print {$OUT}
5218          "Deleting a breakpoint requires a line number, or '*' for all\n"
5219          ;    # hint
5220    }
5221
5222    return;
5223} ## end sub cmd_B
5224
5225=head3 delete_breakpoint([line]) (API)
5226
5227This actually does the work of deleting either a single breakpoint, or all
5228of them.
5229
5230For a single line, we look for it in C<@dbline>. If it's nonbreakable, we
5231just drop out with a message saying so. If it is, we remove the condition
5232part of the 'condition\0action' that says there's a breakpoint here. If,
5233after we've done that, there's nothing left, we delete the corresponding
5234line in C<%dbline> to signal that no action needs to be taken for this line.
5235
5236For all breakpoints, we iterate through the keys of C<%had_breakpoints>,
5237which lists all currently-loaded files which have breakpoints. We then look
5238at each line in each of these files, temporarily switching the C<%dbline>
5239and C<@dbline> structures to point to the files in question, and do what
5240we did in the single line case: delete the condition in C<@dbline>, and
5241delete the key in C<%dbline> if nothing's left.
5242
5243We then wholesale delete C<%postponed>, C<%postponed_file>, and
5244C<%break_on_load>, because these structures contain breakpoints for files
5245and code that haven't been loaded yet. We can just kill these off because there
5246are no magical debugger structures associated with them.
5247
5248=cut
5249
5250sub _remove_breakpoint_entry {
5251    my ($fn, $i) = @_;
5252
5253    delete $dbline{$i};
5254    _delete_breakpoint_data_ref($fn, $i);
5255
5256    return;
5257}
5258
5259sub _delete_all_breakpoints {
5260    print {$OUT} "Deleting all breakpoints...\n";
5261
5262    # %had_breakpoints lists every file that had at least one
5263    # breakpoint in it.
5264    for my $fn ( keys %had_breakpoints ) {
5265
5266        # Switch to the desired file temporarily.
5267        local *dbline = $main::{ '_<' . $fn };
5268
5269        $max = $#dbline;
5270
5271        # For all lines in this file ...
5272        for my $i (1 .. $max) {
5273
5274            # If there's a breakpoint or action on this line ...
5275            if ( defined $dbline{$i} ) {
5276
5277                # ... remove the breakpoint.
5278                $dbline{$i} =~ s/\A[^\0]+//;
5279                if ( $dbline{$i} =~ s/\A\0?\z// ) {
5280                    # Remove the entry altogether if no action is there.
5281                    _remove_breakpoint_entry($fn, $i);
5282                }
5283            } ## end if (defined $dbline{$i...
5284        } ## end for $i (1 .. $max)
5285
5286        # If, after we turn off the "there were breakpoints in this file"
5287        # bit, the entry in %had_breakpoints for this file is zero,
5288        # we should remove this file from the hash.
5289        if ( not $had_breakpoints{$fn} &= (~1) ) {
5290            delete $had_breakpoints{$fn};
5291        }
5292    } ## end for my $fn (keys %had_breakpoints)
5293
5294    # Kill off all the other breakpoints that are waiting for files that
5295    # haven't been loaded yet.
5296    undef %postponed;
5297    undef %postponed_file;
5298    undef %break_on_load;
5299
5300    return;
5301}
5302
5303sub _delete_breakpoint_from_line {
5304    my ($i) = @_;
5305
5306    # Woops. This line wasn't breakable at all.
5307    die "Line $i not breakable.\n" if $dbline[$i] == 0;
5308
5309    # Kill the condition, but leave any action.
5310    $dbline{$i} =~ s/\A[^\0]*//;
5311
5312    # Remove the entry entirely if there's no action left.
5313    if ($dbline{$i} eq '') {
5314        _remove_breakpoint_entry($filename, $i);
5315    }
5316
5317    return;
5318}
5319
5320sub delete_breakpoint {
5321    my $i = shift;
5322
5323    # If we got a line, delete just that one.
5324    if ( defined($i) ) {
5325        _delete_breakpoint_from_line($i);
5326    }
5327    # No line; delete them all.
5328    else {
5329        _delete_all_breakpoints();
5330    }
5331
5332    return;
5333}
5334
5335=head3 cmd_stop (command)
5336
5337This is meant to be part of the new command API, but it isn't called or used
5338anywhere else in the debugger. XXX It is probably meant for use in development
5339of new commands.
5340
5341=cut
5342
5343sub cmd_stop {    # As on ^C, but not signal-safy.
5344    $signal = 1;
5345}
5346
5347=head3 C<cmd_e> - threads
5348
5349Display the current thread id:
5350
5351    e
5352
5353This could be how (when implemented) to send commands to this thread id (e cmd)
5354or that thread id (e tid cmd).
5355
5356=cut
5357
5358sub cmd_e {
5359    my $cmd  = shift;
5360    my $line = shift;
5361    unless (exists($INC{'threads.pm'})) {
5362        print "threads not loaded($ENV{PERL5DB_THREADED})
5363        please run the debugger with PERL5DB_THREADED=1 set in the environment\n";
5364    } else {
5365        my $tid = threads->tid;
5366        print "thread id: $tid\n";
5367    }
5368} ## end sub cmd_e
5369
5370=head3 C<cmd_E> - list of thread ids
5371
5372Display the list of available thread ids:
5373
5374    E
5375
5376This could be used (when implemented) to send commands to all threads (E cmd).
5377
5378=cut
5379
5380sub cmd_E {
5381    my $cmd  = shift;
5382    my $line = shift;
5383    unless (exists($INC{'threads.pm'})) {
5384        print "threads not loaded($ENV{PERL5DB_THREADED})
5385        please run the debugger with PERL5DB_THREADED=1 set in the environment\n";
5386    } else {
5387        my $tid = threads->tid;
5388        print "thread ids: ".join(', ',
5389            map { ($tid == $_->tid ? '<'.$_->tid.'>' : $_->tid) } threads->list
5390        )."\n";
5391    }
5392} ## end sub cmd_E
5393
5394=head3 C<cmd_h> - help command (command)
5395
5396Does the work of either
5397
5398=over 4
5399
5400=item *
5401
5402Showing all the debugger help
5403
5404=item *
5405
5406Showing help for a specific command
5407
5408=back
5409
5410=cut
5411
5412use vars qw($help);
5413use vars qw($summary);
5414
5415sub cmd_h {
5416    my $cmd = shift;
5417
5418    # If we have no operand, assume null.
5419    my $line = shift || '';
5420
5421    # 'h h'. Print the long-format help.
5422    if ( $line =~ /\Ah\s*\z/ ) {
5423        print_help($help);
5424    }
5425
5426    # 'h <something>'. Search for the command and print only its help.
5427    elsif ( my ($asked) = $line =~ /\A(\S.*)\z/ ) {
5428
5429        # support long commands; otherwise bogus errors
5430        # happen when you ask for h on <CR> for example
5431        my $qasked = quotemeta($asked);    # for searching; we don't
5432                                           # want to use it as a pattern.
5433                                           # XXX: finds CR but not <CR>
5434
5435        # Search the help string for the command.
5436        if (
5437            $help =~ /^                    # Start of a line
5438                      <?                   # Optional '<'
5439                      (?:[IB]<)            # Optional markup
5440                      $qasked              # The requested command
5441                     /mx
5442          )
5443        {
5444
5445            # It's there; pull it out and print it.
5446            while (
5447                $help =~ /^
5448                              (<?            # Optional '<'
5449                                 (?:[IB]<)   # Optional markup
5450                                 $qasked     # The command
5451                                 ([\s\S]*?)  # Description line(s)
5452                              \n)            # End of last description line
5453                              (?!\s)         # Next line not starting with
5454                                             # whitespace
5455                             /mgx
5456              )
5457            {
5458                print_help($1);
5459            }
5460        }
5461
5462        # Not found; not a debugger command.
5463        else {
5464            print_help("B<$asked> is not a debugger command.\n");
5465        }
5466    } ## end elsif ($line =~ /^(\S.*)$/)
5467
5468    # 'h' - print the summary help.
5469    else {
5470        print_help($summary);
5471    }
5472} ## end sub cmd_h
5473
5474=head3 C<cmd_i> - inheritance display
5475
5476Display the (nested) parentage of the module or object given.
5477
5478=cut
5479
5480sub cmd_i {
5481    my $cmd  = shift;
5482    my $line = shift;
5483    foreach my $isa ( split( /\s+/, $line ) ) {
5484        $evalarg = $isa;
5485        # The &-call is here to ascertain the mutability of @_.
5486        ($isa) = &DB::eval;
5487        no strict 'refs';
5488        print join(
5489            ', ',
5490            map {
5491                "$_"
5492                  . (
5493                    defined( ${"$_\::VERSION"} )
5494                    ? ' ' . ${"$_\::VERSION"}
5495                    : undef )
5496              } @{mro::get_linear_isa(ref($isa) || $isa)}
5497        );
5498        print "\n";
5499    }
5500} ## end sub cmd_i
5501
5502=head3 C<cmd_l> - list lines (command)
5503
5504Most of the command is taken up with transforming all the different line
5505specification syntaxes into 'start-stop'. After that is done, the command
5506runs a loop over C<@dbline> for the specified range of lines. It handles
5507the printing of each line and any markers (C<==E<gt>> for current line,
5508C<b> for break on this line, C<a> for action on this line, C<:> for this
5509line breakable).
5510
5511We save the last line listed in the C<$start> global for further listing
5512later.
5513
5514=cut
5515
5516sub _min {
5517    my $min = shift;
5518    foreach my $v (@_) {
5519        if ($min > $v) {
5520            $min = $v;
5521        }
5522    }
5523    return $min;
5524}
5525
5526sub _max {
5527    my $max = shift;
5528    foreach my $v (@_) {
5529        if ($max < $v) {
5530            $max = $v;
5531        }
5532    }
5533    return $max;
5534}
5535
5536sub _minify_to_max {
5537    my $ref = shift;
5538
5539    $$ref = _min($$ref, $max);
5540
5541    return;
5542}
5543
5544sub _cmd_l_handle_var_name {
5545    my $var_name = shift;
5546
5547    $evalarg = $var_name;
5548
5549    my ($s) = DB::eval();
5550
5551    # Ooops. Bad scalar.
5552    if ($@) {
5553        print {$OUT} "Error: $@\n";
5554        next CMD;
5555    }
5556
5557    # Good scalar. If it's a reference, find what it points to.
5558    $s = CvGV_name($s);
5559    print {$OUT} "Interpreted as: $1 $s\n";
5560    $line = "$1 $s";
5561
5562    # Call self recursively to really do the command.
5563    return _cmd_l_main( $s );
5564}
5565
5566sub _cmd_l_handle_subname {
5567
5568    my $s = $subname;
5569
5570    # De-Perl4.
5571    $subname =~ s/\'/::/;
5572
5573    # Put it in this package unless it starts with ::.
5574    $subname = $package . "::" . $subname unless $subname =~ /::/;
5575
5576    # Put it in CORE::GLOBAL if t doesn't start with :: and
5577    # it doesn't live in this package and it lives in CORE::GLOBAL.
5578    $subname = "CORE::GLOBAL::$s"
5579    if not defined &$subname
5580        and $s !~ /::/
5581        and defined &{"CORE::GLOBAL::$s"};
5582
5583    # Put leading '::' names into 'main::'.
5584    $subname = "main" . $subname if substr( $subname, 0, 2 ) eq "::";
5585
5586    # Get name:start-stop from find_sub, and break this up at
5587    # colons.
5588    my @pieces = split( /:/, find_sub($subname) || $sub{$subname} );
5589
5590    # Pull off start-stop.
5591    my $subrange = pop @pieces;
5592
5593    # If the name contained colons, the split broke it up.
5594    # Put it back together.
5595    $file = join( ':', @pieces );
5596
5597    # If we're not in that file, switch over to it.
5598    if ( $file ne $filename ) {
5599        if (! $slave_editor) {
5600            print {$OUT} "Switching to file '$file'.\n";
5601        }
5602
5603        # Switch debugger's magic structures.
5604        *dbline   = $main::{ '_<' . $file };
5605        $max      = $#dbline;
5606        $filename = $file;
5607    } ## end if ($file ne $filename)
5608
5609    # Subrange is 'start-stop'. If this is less than a window full,
5610    # swap it to 'start+', which will list a window from the start point.
5611    if ($subrange) {
5612        if ( eval($subrange) < -$window ) {
5613            $subrange =~ s/-.*/+/;
5614        }
5615
5616        # Call self recursively to list the range.
5617        return _cmd_l_main( $subrange );
5618    } ## end if ($subrange)
5619
5620    # Couldn't find it.
5621    else {
5622        print {$OUT} "Subroutine $subname not found.\n";
5623        return;
5624    }
5625}
5626
5627sub _cmd_l_empty {
5628    # Compute new range to list.
5629    $incr = $window - 1;
5630
5631    # Recurse to do it.
5632    return _cmd_l_main( $start . '-' . ( $start + $incr ) );
5633}
5634
5635sub _cmd_l_plus {
5636    my ($new_start, $new_incr) = @_;
5637
5638    # Don't reset start for 'l +nnn'.
5639    $start = $new_start if $new_start;
5640
5641    # Increment for list. Use window size if not specified.
5642    # (Allows 'l +' to work.)
5643    $incr = $new_incr || ($window - 1);
5644
5645    # Create a line range we'll understand, and recurse to do it.
5646    return _cmd_l_main( $start . '-' . ( $start + $incr ) );
5647}
5648
5649sub _cmd_l_calc_initial_end_and_i {
5650    my ($spec, $start_match, $end_match) = @_;
5651
5652    # Determine end point; use end of file if not specified.
5653    my $end = ( !defined $start_match ) ? $max :
5654    ( $end_match ? $end_match : $start_match );
5655
5656    # Go on to the end, and then stop.
5657    _minify_to_max(\$end);
5658
5659    # Determine start line.
5660    my $i = $start_match;
5661
5662    if ($i eq '.') {
5663        $i = $spec;
5664    }
5665
5666    $i = _max($i, 1);
5667
5668    $incr = $end - $i;
5669
5670    return ($end, $i);
5671}
5672
5673sub _cmd_l_range {
5674    my ($spec, $current_line, $start_match, $end_match) = @_;
5675
5676    my ($end, $i) =
5677        _cmd_l_calc_initial_end_and_i($spec, $start_match, $end_match);
5678
5679    # If we're running under a slave editor, force it to show the lines.
5680    if ($slave_editor) {
5681        print {$OUT} "\032\032$filename:$i:0\n";
5682        $i = $end;
5683    }
5684    # We're doing it ourselves. We want to show the line and special
5685    # markers for:
5686    # - the current line in execution
5687    # - whether a line is breakable or not
5688    # - whether a line has a break or not
5689    # - whether a line has an action or not
5690    else {
5691        I_TO_END:
5692        for ( ; $i <= $end ; $i++ ) {
5693
5694            # Check for breakpoints and actions.
5695            my ( $stop, $action );
5696            if ($dbline{$i}) {
5697                ( $stop, $action ) = split( /\0/, $dbline{$i} );
5698            }
5699
5700            # ==> if this is the current line in execution,
5701            # : if it's breakable.
5702            my $arrow =
5703            ( $i == $current_line and $filename eq $filename_ini )
5704            ? '==>'
5705            : ( $dbline[$i] + 0 ? ':' : ' ' );
5706
5707            # Add break and action indicators.
5708            $arrow .= 'b' if $stop;
5709            $arrow .= 'a' if $action;
5710
5711            # Print the line.
5712            print {$OUT} "$i$arrow\t", $dbline[$i];
5713
5714            # Move on to the next line. Drop out on an interrupt.
5715            if ($signal) {
5716                $i++;
5717                last I_TO_END;
5718            }
5719        } ## end for (; $i <= $end ; $i++)
5720
5721        # Line the prompt up; print a newline if the last line listed
5722        # didn't have a newline.
5723        if ($dbline[ $i - 1 ] !~ /\n\z/) {
5724            print {$OUT} "\n";
5725        }
5726    } ## end else [ if ($slave_editor)
5727
5728    # Save the point we last listed to in case another relative 'l'
5729    # command is desired. Don't let it run off the end.
5730    $start = $i;
5731    _minify_to_max(\$start);
5732
5733    return;
5734}
5735
5736sub _cmd_l_main {
5737    my $spec = shift;
5738
5739    # If this is '-something', delete any spaces after the dash.
5740    $spec =~ s/\A-\s*\z/-/;
5741
5742    # If the line is '$something', assume this is a scalar containing a
5743    # line number.
5744    # Set up for DB::eval() - evaluate in *user* context.
5745    if ( my ($var_name) = $spec =~ /\A(\$.*)/s ) {
5746        return _cmd_l_handle_var_name($var_name);
5747    }
5748    # l name. Try to find a sub by that name.
5749    elsif ( ($subname) = $spec =~ /\A([\':A-Za-z_][\':\w]*(?:\[.*\])?)/s ) {
5750        return _cmd_l_handle_subname();
5751    }
5752    # Bare 'l' command.
5753    elsif ( $spec !~ /\S/ ) {
5754        return _cmd_l_empty();
5755    }
5756    # l [start]+number_of_lines
5757    elsif ( my ($new_start, $new_incr) = $spec =~ /\A(\d*)\+(\d*)\z/ ) {
5758        return _cmd_l_plus($new_start, $new_incr);
5759    }
5760    # l start-stop or l start,stop
5761    elsif (my ($s, $e) = $spec =~ /^(?:(-?[\d\$\.]+)(?:[-,]([\d\$\.]+))?)?/ ) {
5762        return _cmd_l_range($spec, $line, $s, $e);
5763    }
5764
5765    return;
5766} ## end sub cmd_l
5767
5768sub cmd_l {
5769    my (undef, $line) = @_;
5770
5771    return _cmd_l_main($line);
5772}
5773
5774=head3 C<cmd_L> - list breakpoints, actions, and watch expressions (command)
5775
5776To list breakpoints, the command has to look determine where all of them are
5777first. It starts a C<%had_breakpoints>, which tells us what all files have
5778breakpoints and/or actions. For each file, we switch the C<*dbline> glob (the
5779magic source and breakpoint data structures) to the file, and then look
5780through C<%dbline> for lines with breakpoints and/or actions, listing them
5781out. We look through C<%postponed> not-yet-compiled subroutines that have
5782breakpoints, and through C<%postponed_file> for not-yet-C<require>'d files
5783that have breakpoints.
5784
5785Watchpoints are simpler: we just list the entries in C<@to_watch>.
5786
5787=cut
5788
5789sub _cmd_L_calc_arg {
5790    # If no argument, list everything. Pre-5.8.0 version always lists
5791    # everything
5792    my $arg = shift || 'abw';
5793    if ($CommandSet ne '580')
5794    {
5795        $arg = 'abw';
5796    }
5797
5798    return $arg;
5799}
5800
5801sub _cmd_L_calc_wanted_flags {
5802    my $arg = _cmd_L_calc_arg(shift);
5803
5804    return (map { index($arg, $_) >= 0 ? 1 : 0 } qw(a b w));
5805}
5806
5807
5808sub _cmd_L_handle_breakpoints {
5809    my ($handle_db_line) = @_;
5810
5811    BREAKPOINTS_SCAN:
5812    # Look in all the files with breakpoints...
5813    for my $file ( keys %had_breakpoints ) {
5814
5815        # Temporary switch to this file.
5816        local *dbline = $main::{ '_<' . $file };
5817
5818        # Set up to look through the whole file.
5819        $max = $#dbline;
5820        my $was;    # Flag: did we print something
5821        # in this file?
5822
5823        # For each line in the file ...
5824        for my $i (1 .. $max) {
5825
5826            # We've got something on this line.
5827            if ( defined $dbline{$i} ) {
5828
5829                # Print the header if we haven't.
5830                if (not $was++) {
5831                    print {$OUT} "$file:\n";
5832                }
5833
5834                # Print the line.
5835                print {$OUT} " $i:\t", $dbline[$i];
5836
5837                $handle_db_line->($dbline{$i});
5838
5839                # Quit if the user hit interrupt.
5840                if ($signal) {
5841                    last BREAKPOINTS_SCAN;
5842                }
5843            } ## end if (defined $dbline{$i...
5844        } ## end for my $i (1 .. $max)
5845    } ## end for my $file (keys %had_breakpoints)
5846
5847    return;
5848}
5849
5850sub _cmd_L_handle_postponed_breakpoints {
5851    my ($handle_db_line) = @_;
5852
5853    print {$OUT} "Postponed breakpoints in files:\n";
5854
5855    POSTPONED_SCANS:
5856    for my $file ( keys %postponed_file ) {
5857        my $db = $postponed_file{$file};
5858        print {$OUT} " $file:\n";
5859        for my $line ( sort { $a <=> $b } keys %$db ) {
5860            print {$OUT} "  $line:\n";
5861
5862            $handle_db_line->($db->{$line});
5863
5864            if ($signal) {
5865                last POSTPONED_SCANS;
5866            }
5867        }
5868        if ($signal) {
5869            last POSTPONED_SCANS;
5870        }
5871    }
5872
5873    return;
5874}
5875
5876
5877sub cmd_L {
5878    my $cmd = shift;
5879
5880    my ($action_wanted, $break_wanted, $watch_wanted) =
5881        _cmd_L_calc_wanted_flags(shift);
5882
5883    my $handle_db_line = sub {
5884        my ($l) = @_;
5885
5886        my ( $stop, $action ) = split( /\0/, $l );
5887
5888        if ($stop and $break_wanted) {
5889            print {$OUT} "    break if (", $stop, ")\n"
5890        }
5891
5892        if ($action && $action_wanted) {
5893            print {$OUT} "    action:  ", $action, "\n"
5894        }
5895
5896        return;
5897    };
5898
5899    # Breaks and actions are found together, so we look in the same place
5900    # for both.
5901    if ( $break_wanted or $action_wanted ) {
5902        _cmd_L_handle_breakpoints($handle_db_line);
5903    }
5904
5905    # Look for breaks in not-yet-compiled subs:
5906    if ( %postponed and $break_wanted ) {
5907        print {$OUT} "Postponed breakpoints in subroutines:\n";
5908        my $subname;
5909        SUBS_SCAN:
5910        for $subname ( keys %postponed ) {
5911            print {$OUT} " $subname\t$postponed{$subname}\n";
5912            if ($signal) {
5913                last SUBS_SCAN;
5914            }
5915        }
5916    } ## end if (%postponed and $break_wanted)
5917
5918    # Find files that have not-yet-loaded breaks:
5919    my @have = map {    # Combined keys
5920        keys %{ $postponed_file{$_} }
5921    } keys %postponed_file;
5922
5923    # If there are any, list them.
5924    if ( @have and ( $break_wanted or $action_wanted ) ) {
5925        _cmd_L_handle_postponed_breakpoints($handle_db_line);
5926    } ## end if (@have and ($break_wanted...
5927
5928    if ( %break_on_load and $break_wanted ) {
5929        print {$OUT} "Breakpoints on load:\n";
5930        BREAK_ON_LOAD: for my $filename ( keys %break_on_load ) {
5931            print {$OUT} " $filename\n";
5932            last BREAK_ON_LOAD if $signal;
5933        }
5934    } ## end if (%break_on_load and...
5935
5936    if ($watch_wanted and ( $trace & 2 )) {
5937        print {$OUT} "Watch-expressions:\n" if @to_watch;
5938        TO_WATCH: for my $expr (@to_watch) {
5939            print {$OUT} " $expr\n";
5940            last TO_WATCH if $signal;
5941        }
5942    }
5943
5944    return;
5945} ## end sub cmd_L
5946
5947=head3 C<cmd_M> - list modules (command)
5948
5949Just call C<list_modules>.
5950
5951=cut
5952
5953sub cmd_M {
5954    list_modules();
5955
5956    return;
5957}
5958
5959=head3 C<cmd_o> - options (command)
5960
5961If this is just C<o> by itself, we list the current settings via
5962C<dump_option>. If there's a nonblank value following it, we pass that on to
5963C<parse_options> for processing.
5964
5965=cut
5966
5967sub cmd_o {
5968    my $cmd = shift;
5969    my $opt = shift || '';    # opt[=val]
5970
5971    # Nonblank. Try to parse and process.
5972    if ( $opt =~ /^(\S.*)/ ) {
5973        parse_options($1);
5974    }
5975
5976    # Blank. List the current option settings.
5977    else {
5978        for (@options) {
5979            dump_option($_);
5980        }
5981    }
5982} ## end sub cmd_o
5983
5984=head3 C<cmd_O> - nonexistent in 5.8.x (command)
5985
5986Advises the user that the O command has been renamed.
5987
5988=cut
5989
5990sub cmd_O {
5991    print $OUT "The old O command is now the o command.\n";             # hint
5992    print $OUT "Use 'h' to get current command help synopsis or\n";     #
5993    print $OUT "use 'o CommandSet=pre580' to revert to old usage\n";    #
5994}
5995
5996=head3 C<cmd_v> - view window (command)
5997
5998Uses the C<$preview> variable set in the second C<BEGIN> block (q.v.) to
5999move back a few lines to list the selected line in context. Uses C<cmd_l>
6000to do the actual listing after figuring out the range of line to request.
6001
6002=cut
6003
6004use vars qw($preview);
6005
6006sub cmd_v {
6007    my $cmd  = shift;
6008    my $line = shift;
6009
6010    # Extract the line to list around. (Astute readers will have noted that
6011    # this pattern will match whether or not a numeric line is specified,
6012    # which means that we'll always enter this loop (though a non-numeric
6013    # argument results in no action at all)).
6014    if ( $line =~ /^(\d*)$/ ) {
6015
6016        # Total number of lines to list (a windowful).
6017        $incr = $window - 1;
6018
6019        # Set the start to the argument given (if there was one).
6020        $start = $1 if $1;
6021
6022        # Back up by the context amount.
6023        $start -= $preview;
6024
6025        # Put together a linespec that cmd_l will like.
6026        $line = $start . '-' . ( $start + $incr );
6027
6028        # List the lines.
6029        cmd_l( 'l', $line );
6030    } ## end if ($line =~ /^(\d*)$/)
6031} ## end sub cmd_v
6032
6033=head3 C<cmd_w> - add a watch expression (command)
6034
6035The 5.8 version of this command adds a watch expression if one is specified;
6036it does nothing if entered with no operands.
6037
6038We extract the expression, save it, evaluate it in the user's context, and
6039save the value. We'll re-evaluate it each time the debugger passes a line,
6040and will stop (see the code at the top of the command loop) if the value
6041of any of the expressions changes.
6042
6043=cut
6044
6045sub _add_watch_expr {
6046    my $expr = shift;
6047
6048    # ... save it.
6049    push @to_watch, $expr;
6050
6051    # Parameterize DB::eval and call it to get the expression's value
6052    # in the user's context. This version can handle expressions which
6053    # return a list value.
6054    $evalarg = $expr;
6055    # The &-call is here to ascertain the mutability of @_.
6056    my ($val) = join( ' ', &DB::eval);
6057    $val = ( defined $val ) ? "'$val'" : 'undef';
6058
6059    # Save the current value of the expression.
6060    push @old_watch, $val;
6061
6062    # We are now watching expressions.
6063    $trace |= 2;
6064
6065    return;
6066}
6067
6068sub cmd_w {
6069    my $cmd = shift;
6070
6071    # Null expression if no arguments.
6072    my $expr = shift || '';
6073
6074    # If expression is not null ...
6075    if ( $expr =~ /\A\S/ ) {
6076        _add_watch_expr($expr);
6077    } ## end if ($expr =~ /^(\S.*)/)
6078
6079    # You have to give one to get one.
6080    else {
6081        print $OUT "Adding a watch-expression requires an expression\n";  # hint
6082    }
6083
6084    return;
6085}
6086
6087=head3 C<cmd_W> - delete watch expressions (command)
6088
6089This command accepts either a watch expression to be removed from the list
6090of watch expressions, or C<*> to delete them all.
6091
6092If C<*> is specified, we simply empty the watch expression list and the
6093watch expression value list. We also turn off the bit that says we've got
6094watch expressions.
6095
6096If an expression (or partial expression) is specified, we pattern-match
6097through the expressions and remove the ones that match. We also discard
6098the corresponding values. If no watch expressions are left, we turn off
6099the I<watching expressions> bit.
6100
6101=cut
6102
6103sub cmd_W {
6104    my $cmd  = shift;
6105    my $expr = shift || '';
6106
6107    # Delete them all.
6108    if ( $expr eq '*' ) {
6109
6110        # Not watching now.
6111        $trace &= ~2;
6112
6113        print $OUT "Deleting all watch expressions ...\n";
6114
6115        # And all gone.
6116        @to_watch = @old_watch = ();
6117    }
6118
6119    # Delete one of them.
6120    elsif ( $expr =~ /^(\S.*)/ ) {
6121
6122        # Where we are in the list.
6123        my $i_cnt = 0;
6124
6125        # For each expression ...
6126        foreach (@to_watch) {
6127            my $val = $to_watch[$i_cnt];
6128
6129            # Does this one match the command argument?
6130            if ( $val eq $expr ) {    # =~ m/^\Q$i$/) {
6131                                      # Yes. Turn it off, and its value too.
6132                splice( @to_watch,  $i_cnt, 1 );
6133                splice( @old_watch, $i_cnt, 1 );
6134            }
6135            $i_cnt++;
6136        } ## end foreach (@to_watch)
6137
6138        # We don't bother to turn watching off because
6139        #  a) we don't want to stop calling watchfunction() if it exists
6140        #  b) foreach over a null list doesn't do anything anyway
6141
6142    } ## end elsif ($expr =~ /^(\S.*)/)
6143
6144    # No command arguments entered.
6145    else {
6146        print $OUT
6147          "Deleting a watch-expression requires an expression, or '*' for all\n"
6148          ;    # hint
6149    }
6150} ## end sub cmd_W
6151
6152### END of the API section
6153
6154=head1 SUPPORT ROUTINES
6155
6156These are general support routines that are used in a number of places
6157throughout the debugger.
6158
6159=head2 save
6160
6161save() saves the user's versions of globals that would mess us up in C<@saved>,
6162and installs the versions we like better.
6163
6164=cut
6165
6166sub save {
6167
6168    # Save eval failure, command failure, extended OS error, output field
6169    # separator, input record separator, output record separator and
6170    # the warning setting.
6171    @saved = ( $@, $!, $^E, $,, $/, $\, $^W );
6172
6173    $,  = "";      # output field separator is null string
6174    $/  = "\n";    # input record separator is newline
6175    $\  = "";      # output record separator is null string
6176    $^W = 0;       # warnings are off
6177} ## end sub save
6178
6179=head2 C<print_lineinfo> - show where we are now
6180
6181print_lineinfo prints whatever it is that it is handed; it prints it to the
6182C<$LINEINFO> filehandle instead of just printing it to STDOUT. This allows
6183us to feed line information to a slave editor without messing up the
6184debugger output.
6185
6186=cut
6187
6188sub print_lineinfo {
6189
6190    # Make the terminal sensible if we're not the primary debugger.
6191    resetterm(1) if $LINEINFO eq $OUT and $term_pid != $$;
6192    local $\ = '';
6193    local $, = '';
6194    # $LINEINFO may be undef if $noTTY is set or some other issue.
6195    if ($LINEINFO)
6196    {
6197        print {$LINEINFO} @_;
6198    }
6199} ## end sub print_lineinfo
6200
6201=head2 C<postponed_sub>
6202
6203Handles setting postponed breakpoints in subroutines once they're compiled.
6204For breakpoints, we use C<DB::find_sub> to locate the source file and line
6205range for the subroutine, then mark the file as having a breakpoint,
6206temporarily switch the C<*dbline> glob over to the source file, and then
6207search the given range of lines to find a breakable line. If we find one,
6208we set the breakpoint on it, deleting the breakpoint from C<%postponed>.
6209
6210=cut
6211
6212# The following takes its argument via $evalarg to preserve current @_
6213
6214sub postponed_sub {
6215
6216    # Get the subroutine name.
6217    my $subname = shift;
6218
6219    # If this is a 'break +<n> if <condition>' ...
6220    if ( $postponed{$subname} =~ s/^break\s([+-]?\d+)\s+if\s// ) {
6221
6222        # If there's no offset, use '+0'.
6223        my $offset = $1 || 0;
6224
6225        # find_sub's value is 'fullpath-filename:start-stop'. It's
6226        # possible that the filename might have colons in it too.
6227        my ( $file, $i ) = ( find_sub($subname) =~ /^(.*):(\d+)-.*$/ );
6228        if ($i) {
6229
6230            # We got the start line. Add the offset '+<n>' from
6231            # $postponed{subname}.
6232            $i += $offset;
6233
6234            # Switch to the file this sub is in, temporarily.
6235            local *dbline = $main::{ '_<' . $file };
6236
6237            # No warnings, please.
6238            local $^W = 0;    # != 0 is magical below
6239
6240            # This file's got a breakpoint in it.
6241            $had_breakpoints{$file} |= 1;
6242
6243            # Last line in file.
6244            $max = $#dbline;
6245
6246            # Search forward until we hit a breakable line or get to
6247            # the end of the file.
6248            ++$i until $dbline[$i] != 0 or $i >= $max;
6249
6250            # Copy the breakpoint in and delete it from %postponed.
6251            $dbline{$i} = delete $postponed{$subname};
6252        } ## end if ($i)
6253
6254        # find_sub didn't find the sub.
6255        else {
6256            local $\ = '';
6257            print $OUT "Subroutine $subname not found.\n";
6258        }
6259        return;
6260    } ## end if ($postponed{$subname...
6261    elsif ( $postponed{$subname} eq 'compile' ) { $signal = 1 }
6262
6263    #print $OUT "In postponed_sub for '$subname'.\n";
6264} ## end sub postponed_sub
6265
6266=head2 C<postponed>
6267
6268Called after each required file is compiled, but before it is executed;
6269also called if the name of a just-compiled subroutine is a key of
6270C<%postponed>. Propagates saved breakpoints (from C<b compile>, C<b load>,
6271etc.) into the just-compiled code.
6272
6273If this is a C<require>'d file, the incoming parameter is the glob
6274C<*{"_<$filename"}>, with C<$filename> the name of the C<require>'d file.
6275
6276If it's a subroutine, the incoming parameter is the subroutine name.
6277
6278=cut
6279
6280sub postponed {
6281
6282    # If there's a break, process it.
6283    if ($ImmediateStop) {
6284
6285        # Right, we've stopped. Turn it off.
6286        $ImmediateStop = 0;
6287
6288        # Enter the command loop when DB::DB gets called.
6289        $signal = 1;
6290    }
6291
6292    # If this is a subroutine, let postponed_sub() deal with it.
6293    if (ref(\$_[0]) ne 'GLOB') {
6294        return postponed_sub(@_);
6295    }
6296
6297    # Not a subroutine. Deal with the file.
6298    local *dbline = shift;
6299    my $filename = $dbline;
6300    $filename =~ s/^_<//;
6301    local $\ = '';
6302    $signal = 1, print $OUT "'$filename' loaded...\n"
6303      if $break_on_load{$filename};
6304    print_lineinfo( ' ' x $stack_depth, "Package $filename.\n" ) if $frame;
6305
6306    # Do we have any breakpoints to put in this file?
6307    return unless $postponed_file{$filename};
6308
6309    # Yes. Mark this file as having breakpoints.
6310    $had_breakpoints{$filename} |= 1;
6311
6312    # "Cannot be done: insufficient magic" - we can't just put the
6313    # breakpoints saved in %postponed_file into %dbline by assigning
6314    # the whole hash; we have to do it one item at a time for the
6315    # breakpoints to be set properly.
6316    #%dbline = %{$postponed_file{$filename}};
6317
6318    # Set the breakpoints, one at a time.
6319    my $key;
6320
6321    for $key ( keys %{ $postponed_file{$filename} } ) {
6322
6323        # Stash the saved breakpoint into the current file's magic line array.
6324        $dbline{$key} = ${ $postponed_file{$filename} }{$key};
6325    }
6326
6327    # This file's been compiled; discard the stored breakpoints.
6328    delete $postponed_file{$filename};
6329
6330} ## end sub postponed
6331
6332=head2 C<dumpit>
6333
6334C<dumpit> is the debugger's wrapper around dumpvar.pl.
6335
6336It gets a filehandle (to which C<dumpvar.pl>'s output will be directed) and
6337a reference to a variable (the thing to be dumped) as its input.
6338
6339The incoming filehandle is selected for output (C<dumpvar.pl> is printing to
6340the currently-selected filehandle, thank you very much). The current
6341values of the package globals C<$single> and C<$trace> are backed up in
6342lexicals, and they are turned off (this keeps the debugger from trying
6343to single-step through C<dumpvar.pl> (I think.)). C<$frame> is localized to
6344preserve its current value and it is set to zero to prevent entry/exit
6345messages from printing, and C<$doret> is localized as well and set to -2 to
6346prevent return values from being shown.
6347
6348C<dumpit()> then checks to see if it needs to load C<dumpvar.pl> and
6349tries to load it (note: if you have a C<dumpvar.pl>  ahead of the
6350installed version in C<@INC>, yours will be used instead. Possible security
6351problem?).
6352
6353It then checks to see if the subroutine C<main::dumpValue> is now defined
6354it should have been defined by C<dumpvar.pl>). If it has, C<dumpit()>
6355localizes the globals necessary for things to be sane when C<main::dumpValue()>
6356is called, and picks up the variable to be dumped from the parameter list.
6357
6358It checks the package global C<%options> to see if there's a C<dumpDepth>
6359specified. If not, -1 is assumed; if so, the supplied value gets passed on to
6360C<dumpvar.pl>. This tells C<dumpvar.pl> where to leave off when dumping a
6361structure: -1 means dump everything.
6362
6363C<dumpValue()> is then called if possible; if not, C<dumpit()>just prints a
6364warning.
6365
6366In either case, C<$single>, C<$trace>, C<$frame>, and C<$doret> are restored
6367and we then return to the caller.
6368
6369=cut
6370
6371sub dumpit {
6372
6373    # Save the current output filehandle and switch to the one
6374    # passed in as the first parameter.
6375    my $savout = select(shift);
6376
6377    # Save current settings of $single and $trace, and then turn them off.
6378    my $osingle = $single;
6379    my $otrace  = $trace;
6380    $single = $trace = 0;
6381
6382    # XXX Okay, what do $frame and $doret do, again?
6383    local $frame = 0;
6384    local $doret = -2;
6385
6386    # Load dumpvar.pl unless we've already got the sub we need from it.
6387    unless ( defined &main::dumpValue ) {
6388        do 'dumpvar.pl' or die $@;
6389    }
6390
6391    # If the load succeeded (or we already had dumpvalue()), go ahead
6392    # and dump things.
6393    if ( defined &main::dumpValue ) {
6394        local $\ = '';
6395        local $, = '';
6396        local $" = ' ';
6397        my $v = shift;
6398        my $maxdepth = shift || $option{dumpDepth};
6399        $maxdepth = -1 unless defined $maxdepth;    # -1 means infinite depth
6400        main::dumpValue( $v, $maxdepth );
6401    } ## end if (defined &main::dumpValue)
6402
6403    # Oops, couldn't load dumpvar.pl.
6404    else {
6405        local $\ = '';
6406        print $OUT "dumpvar.pl not available.\n";
6407    }
6408
6409    # Reset $single and $trace to their old values.
6410    $single = $osingle;
6411    $trace  = $otrace;
6412
6413    # Restore the old filehandle.
6414    select($savout);
6415} ## end sub dumpit
6416
6417=head2 C<print_trace>
6418
6419C<print_trace>'s job is to print a stack trace. It does this via the
6420C<dump_trace> routine, which actually does all the ferreting-out of the
6421stack trace data. C<print_trace> takes care of formatting it nicely and
6422printing it to the proper filehandle.
6423
6424Parameters:
6425
6426=over 4
6427
6428=item *
6429
6430The filehandle to print to.
6431
6432=item *
6433
6434How many frames to skip before starting trace.
6435
6436=item *
6437
6438How many frames to print.
6439
6440=item *
6441
6442A flag: if true, print a I<short> trace without filenames, line numbers, or arguments
6443
6444=back
6445
6446The original comment below seems to be noting that the traceback may not be
6447correct if this routine is called in a tied method.
6448
6449=cut
6450
6451# Tied method do not create a context, so may get wrong message:
6452
6453sub print_trace {
6454    local $\ = '';
6455    my $fh = shift;
6456
6457    # If this is going to a slave editor, but we're not the primary
6458    # debugger, reset it first.
6459    resetterm(1)
6460      if $fh        eq $LINEINFO    # slave editor
6461      and $LINEINFO eq $OUT         # normal output
6462      and $term_pid != $$;          # not the primary
6463
6464    # Collect the actual trace information to be formatted.
6465    # This is an array of hashes of subroutine call info.
6466    my @sub = dump_trace( $_[0] + 1, $_[1] );
6467
6468    # Grab the "short report" flag from @_.
6469    my $short = $_[2];              # Print short report, next one for sub name
6470
6471    # Run through the traceback info, format it, and print it.
6472    my $s;
6473    for my $i (0 .. $#sub) {
6474
6475        # Drop out if the user has lost interest and hit control-C.
6476        last if $signal;
6477
6478        # Set the separator so arrays print nice.
6479        local $" = ', ';
6480
6481        # Grab and stringify the arguments if they are there.
6482        my $args =
6483          defined $sub[$i]{args}
6484          ? "(@{ $sub[$i]{args} })"
6485          : '';
6486
6487        # Shorten them up if $maxtrace says they're too long.
6488        $args = ( substr $args, 0, $maxtrace - 3 ) . '...'
6489          if length $args > $maxtrace;
6490
6491        # Get the file name.
6492        my $file = $sub[$i]{file};
6493
6494        # Put in a filename header if short is off.
6495        $file = $file eq '-e' ? $file : "file '$file'" unless $short;
6496
6497        # Get the actual sub's name, and shorten to $maxtrace's requirement.
6498        $s = $sub[$i]{'sub'};
6499        $s = ( substr $s, 0, $maxtrace - 3 ) . '...' if length $s > $maxtrace;
6500
6501        # Short report uses trimmed file and sub names.
6502        if ($short) {
6503            my $sub = @_ >= 4 ? $_[3] : $s;
6504            print $fh "$sub[$i]{context}=$sub$args from $file:$sub[$i]{line}\n";
6505        } ## end if ($short)
6506
6507        # Non-short report includes full names.
6508        else {
6509            print $fh "$sub[$i]{context} = $s$args"
6510              . " called from $file"
6511              . " line $sub[$i]{line}\n";
6512        }
6513    } ## end for my $i (0 .. $#sub)
6514} ## end sub print_trace
6515
6516=head2 dump_trace(skip[,count])
6517
6518Actually collect the traceback information available via C<caller()>. It does
6519some filtering and cleanup of the data, but mostly it just collects it to
6520make C<print_trace()>'s job easier.
6521
6522C<skip> defines the number of stack frames to be skipped, working backwards
6523from the most current. C<count> determines the total number of frames to
6524be returned; all of them (well, the first 10^9) are returned if C<count>
6525is omitted.
6526
6527This routine returns a list of hashes, from most-recent to least-recent
6528stack frame. Each has the following keys and values:
6529
6530=over 4
6531
6532=item * C<context> - C<.> (null), C<$> (scalar), or C<@> (array)
6533
6534=item * C<sub> - subroutine name, or C<eval> information
6535
6536=item * C<args> - undef, or a reference to an array of arguments
6537
6538=item * C<file> - the file in which this item was defined (if any)
6539
6540=item * C<line> - the line on which it was defined
6541
6542=back
6543
6544=cut
6545
6546sub _dump_trace_calc_saved_single_arg
6547{
6548    my ($nothard, $arg) = @_;
6549
6550    my $type;
6551    if ( not defined $arg ) {    # undefined parameter
6552        return "undef";
6553    }
6554
6555    elsif ( $nothard and tied $arg ) {    # tied parameter
6556        return "tied";
6557    }
6558    elsif ( $nothard and $type = ref $arg ) {    # reference
6559        return "ref($type)";
6560    }
6561    else {                                       # can be stringified
6562        local $_ =
6563        "$arg";    # Safe to stringify now - should not call f().
6564
6565        # Backslash any single-quotes or backslashes.
6566        s/([\'\\])/\\$1/g;
6567
6568        # Single-quote it unless it's a number or a colon-separated
6569        # name.
6570        s/(.*)/'$1'/s
6571        unless /^(?: -?[\d.]+ | \*[\w:]* )$/x;
6572
6573        # Turn high-bit characters into meta-whatever, and controls into like
6574        # '^D'.
6575        require 'meta_notation.pm';
6576        $_ = _meta_notation($_) if /[[:^print:]]/a;
6577
6578        return $_;
6579    }
6580}
6581
6582sub _dump_trace_calc_save_args {
6583    my ($nothard) = @_;
6584
6585    return [
6586        map { _dump_trace_calc_saved_single_arg($nothard, $_) } @args
6587    ];
6588}
6589
6590sub dump_trace {
6591
6592    # How many levels to skip.
6593    my $skip = shift;
6594
6595    # How many levels to show. (1e9 is a cheap way of saying "all of them";
6596    # it's unlikely that we'll have more than a billion stack frames. If you
6597    # do, you've got an awfully big machine...)
6598    my $count = shift || 1e9;
6599
6600    # We increment skip because caller(1) is the first level *back* from
6601    # the current one.  Add $skip to the count of frames so we have a
6602    # simple stop criterion, counting from $skip to $count+$skip.
6603    $skip++;
6604    $count += $skip;
6605
6606    # These variables are used to capture output from caller();
6607    my ( $p, $file, $line, $sub, $h, $context );
6608
6609    my ( $e, $r, @sub, $args );
6610
6611    # XXX Okay... why'd we do that?
6612    my $nothard = not $frame & 8;
6613    local $frame = 0;
6614
6615    # Do not want to trace this.
6616    my $otrace = $trace;
6617    $trace = 0;
6618
6619    # Start out at the skip count.
6620    # If we haven't reached the number of frames requested, and caller() is
6621    # still returning something, stay in the loop. (If we pass the requested
6622    # number of stack frames, or we run out - caller() returns nothing - we
6623    # quit.
6624    # Up the stack frame index to go back one more level each time.
6625    for (
6626        my $i = $skip ;
6627        $i < $count
6628        and ( $p, $file, $line, $sub, $h, $context, $e, $r ) = caller($i) ;
6629        $i++
6630    )
6631    {
6632        # if the sub has args ($h true), make an anonymous array of the
6633        # dumped args.
6634        my $args = $h ? _dump_trace_calc_save_args($nothard) : undef;
6635
6636        # If context is true, this is array (@)context.
6637        # If context is false, this is scalar ($) context.
6638        # If neither, context isn't defined. (This is apparently a 'can't
6639        # happen' trap.)
6640        $context = $context ? '@' : ( defined $context ? "\$" : '.' );
6641
6642        # remove trailing newline-whitespace-semicolon-end of line sequence
6643        # from the eval text, if any.
6644        $e =~ s/\n\s*\;\s*\Z// if $e;
6645
6646        # Escape backslashed single-quotes again if necessary.
6647        $e =~ s/([\\\'])/\\$1/g if $e;
6648
6649        # if the require flag is true, the eval text is from a require.
6650        if ($r) {
6651            $sub = "require '$e'";
6652        }
6653
6654        # if it's false, the eval text is really from an eval.
6655        elsif ( defined $r ) {
6656            $sub = "eval '$e'";
6657        }
6658
6659        # If the sub is '(eval)', this is a block eval, meaning we don't
6660        # know what the eval'ed text actually was.
6661        elsif ( $sub eq '(eval)' ) {
6662            $sub = "eval {...}";
6663        }
6664
6665        # Stick the collected information into @sub as an anonymous hash.
6666        push(
6667            @sub,
6668            {
6669                context => $context,
6670                sub     => $sub,
6671                args    => $args,
6672                file    => $file,
6673                line    => $line
6674            }
6675        );
6676
6677        # Stop processing frames if the user hit control-C.
6678        last if $signal;
6679    } ## end for ($i = $skip ; $i < ...
6680
6681    # Restore the trace value again.
6682    $trace = $otrace;
6683    @sub;
6684} ## end sub dump_trace
6685
6686=head2 C<action()>
6687
6688C<action()> takes input provided as the argument to an add-action command,
6689either pre- or post-, and makes sure it's a complete command. It doesn't do
6690any fancy parsing; it just keeps reading input until it gets a string
6691without a trailing backslash.
6692
6693=cut
6694
6695sub action {
6696    my $action = shift;
6697
6698    while ( $action =~ s/\\$// ) {
6699
6700        # We have a backslash on the end. Read more.
6701        $action .= gets();
6702    } ## end while ($action =~ s/\\$//)
6703
6704    # Return the assembled action.
6705    $action;
6706} ## end sub action
6707
6708=head2 unbalanced
6709
6710This routine mostly just packages up a regular expression to be used
6711to check that the thing it's being matched against has properly-matched
6712curly braces.
6713
6714Of note is the definition of the C<$balanced_brace_re> global via C<||=>, which
6715speeds things up by only creating the qr//'ed expression once; if it's
6716already defined, we don't try to define it again. A speed hack.
6717
6718=cut
6719
6720use vars qw($balanced_brace_re);
6721
6722sub unbalanced {
6723
6724    # I hate using globals!
6725    $balanced_brace_re ||= qr{
6726        ^ \{
6727             (?:
6728                 (?> [^{}] + )              # Non-parens without backtracking
6729                |
6730                 (??{ $balanced_brace_re }) # Group with matching parens
6731              ) *
6732          \} $
6733   }x;
6734    return $_[0] !~ m/$balanced_brace_re/;
6735} ## end sub unbalanced
6736
6737=head2 C<gets()>
6738
6739C<gets()> is a primitive (very primitive) routine to read continuations.
6740It was devised for reading continuations for actions.
6741it just reads more input with C<readline()> and returns it.
6742
6743=cut
6744
6745sub gets {
6746    return DB::readline("cont: ");
6747}
6748
6749=head2 C<_db_system()> - handle calls to<system()> without messing up the debugger
6750
6751The C<system()> function assumes that it can just go ahead and use STDIN and
6752STDOUT, but under the debugger, we want it to use the debugger's input and
6753outout filehandles.
6754
6755C<_db_system()> socks away the program's STDIN and STDOUT, and then substitutes
6756the debugger's IN and OUT filehandles for them. It does the C<system()> call,
6757and then puts everything back again.
6758
6759=cut
6760
6761sub _db_system {
6762
6763    # We save, change, then restore STDIN and STDOUT to avoid fork() since
6764    # some non-Unix systems can do system() but have problems with fork().
6765    open( SAVEIN,  "<&STDIN" )  || _db_warn("Can't save STDIN");
6766    open( SAVEOUT, ">&STDOUT" ) || _db_warn("Can't save STDOUT");
6767    open( STDIN,   "<&IN" )     || _db_warn("Can't redirect STDIN");
6768    open( STDOUT,  ">&OUT" )    || _db_warn("Can't redirect STDOUT");
6769
6770    # XXX: using csh or tcsh destroys sigint retvals!
6771    system(@_);
6772    open( STDIN,  "<&SAVEIN" )  || _db_warn("Can't restore STDIN");
6773    open( STDOUT, ">&SAVEOUT" ) || _db_warn("Can't restore STDOUT");
6774    close(SAVEIN);
6775    close(SAVEOUT);
6776
6777    # most of the $? crud was coping with broken cshisms
6778    if ( $? >> 8 ) {
6779        _db_warn( "(Command exited ", ( $? >> 8 ), ")\n" );
6780    }
6781    elsif ($?) {
6782        _db_warn(
6783            "(Command died of SIG#",
6784            ( $? & 127 ),
6785            ( ( $? & 128 ) ? " -- core dumped" : "" ),
6786            ")", "\n"
6787        );
6788    } ## end elsif ($?)
6789
6790    return $?;
6791
6792} ## end sub system
6793
6794*system = \&_db_system;
6795
6796=head1 TTY MANAGEMENT
6797
6798The subs here do some of the terminal management for multiple debuggers.
6799
6800=head2 setterm
6801
6802Top-level function called when we want to set up a new terminal for use
6803by the debugger.
6804
6805If the C<noTTY> debugger option was set, we'll either use the terminal
6806supplied (the value of the C<noTTY> option), or we'll use C<Term::Rendezvous>
6807to find one. If we're a forked debugger, we call C<resetterm> to try to
6808get a whole new terminal if we can.
6809
6810In either case, we set up the terminal next. If the C<ReadLine> option was
6811true, we'll get a C<Term::ReadLine> object for the current terminal and save
6812the appropriate attributes. We then
6813
6814=cut
6815
6816use vars qw($ornaments);
6817use vars qw($rl_attribs);
6818
6819sub setterm {
6820
6821    # Load Term::Readline, but quietly; don't debug it and don't trace it.
6822    local $frame = 0;
6823    local $doret = -2;
6824    require Term::ReadLine;
6825
6826    # If noTTY is set, but we have a TTY name, go ahead and hook up to it.
6827    if ($notty) {
6828        if ($tty) {
6829            my ( $i, $o ) = split $tty, /,/;
6830            $o = $i unless defined $o;
6831            open( IN,  '<', $i ) or die "Cannot open TTY '$i' for read: $!";
6832            open( OUT, '>', $o ) or die "Cannot open TTY '$o' for write: $!";
6833            $IN  = \*IN;
6834            $OUT = \*OUT;
6835            _autoflush($OUT);
6836        } ## end if ($tty)
6837
6838        # We don't have a TTY - try to find one via Term::Rendezvous.
6839        else {
6840            require Term::Rendezvous;
6841
6842            # See if we have anything to pass to Term::Rendezvous.
6843            # Use $HOME/.perldbtty$$ if not.
6844            my $rv = $ENV{PERLDB_NOTTY} || "$ENV{HOME}/.perldbtty$$";
6845
6846            # Rendezvous and get the filehandles.
6847            my $term_rv = Term::Rendezvous->new( $rv );
6848            $IN  = $term_rv->IN;
6849            $OUT = $term_rv->OUT;
6850        } ## end else [ if ($tty)
6851    } ## end if ($notty)
6852
6853    # We're a daughter debugger. Try to fork off another TTY.
6854    if ( $term_pid eq '-1' ) {    # In a TTY with another debugger
6855        resetterm(2);
6856    }
6857
6858    # If we shouldn't use Term::ReadLine, don't.
6859    if ( !$rl ) {
6860        $term = Term::ReadLine::Stub->new( 'perldb', $IN, $OUT );
6861    }
6862
6863    # We're using Term::ReadLine. Get all the attributes for this terminal.
6864    else {
6865        $term = Term::ReadLine->new( 'perldb', $IN, $OUT );
6866
6867        $rl_attribs = $term->Attribs;
6868        $rl_attribs->{basic_word_break_characters} .= '-:+/*,[])}'
6869          if defined $rl_attribs->{basic_word_break_characters}
6870          and index( $rl_attribs->{basic_word_break_characters}, ":" ) == -1;
6871        $rl_attribs->{special_prefixes} = '$@&%';
6872        $rl_attribs->{completer_word_break_characters} .= '$@&%';
6873        $rl_attribs->{completion_function} = \&db_complete;
6874    } ## end else [ if (!$rl)
6875
6876    # Set up the LINEINFO filehandle.
6877    $LINEINFO = $OUT     unless defined $LINEINFO;
6878    $lineinfo = $console unless defined $lineinfo;
6879
6880    $term->MinLine(2);
6881
6882    load_hist();
6883
6884    if ( $term->Features->{setHistory} and "@hist" ne "?" ) {
6885        $term->SetHistory(@hist);
6886    }
6887
6888    # XXX Ornaments are turned on unconditionally, which is not
6889    # always a good thing.
6890    ornaments($ornaments) if defined $ornaments;
6891    $term_pid = $$;
6892} ## end sub setterm
6893
6894sub load_hist {
6895    $histfile //= option_val("HistFile", undef);
6896    return unless defined $histfile;
6897    open my $fh, "<", $histfile or return;
6898    local $/ = "\n";
6899    @hist = ();
6900    while (<$fh>) {
6901        chomp;
6902        push @hist, $_;
6903    }
6904    close $fh;
6905}
6906
6907sub save_hist {
6908    return unless defined $histfile;
6909    eval { require File::Path } or return;
6910    eval { require File::Basename } or return;
6911    File::Path::mkpath(File::Basename::dirname($histfile));
6912    open my $fh, ">", $histfile or die "Could not open '$histfile': $!";
6913    $histsize //= option_val("HistSize",100);
6914    my @copy = grep { $_ ne '?' } @hist;
6915    my $start = scalar(@copy) > $histsize ? scalar(@copy)-$histsize : 0;
6916    for ($start .. $#copy) {
6917        print $fh "$copy[$_]\n";
6918    }
6919    close $fh or die "Could not write '$histfile': $!";
6920}
6921
6922=head1 GET_FORK_TTY EXAMPLE FUNCTIONS
6923
6924When the process being debugged forks, or the process invokes a command
6925via C<system()> which starts a new debugger, we need to be able to get a new
6926C<IN> and C<OUT> filehandle for the new debugger. Otherwise, the two processes
6927fight over the terminal, and you can never quite be sure who's going to get the
6928input you're typing.
6929
6930C<get_fork_TTY> is a glob-aliased function which calls the real function that
6931is tasked with doing all the necessary operating system mojo to get a new
6932TTY (and probably another window) and to direct the new debugger to read and
6933write there.
6934
6935The debugger provides C<get_fork_TTY> functions which work for TCP
6936socket servers, X11, OS/2, and Mac OS X. Other systems are not
6937supported. You are encouraged to write C<get_fork_TTY> functions which
6938work for I<your> platform and contribute them.
6939
6940=head3 C<socket_get_fork_TTY>
6941
6942=cut
6943
6944sub connect_remoteport {
6945    require IO::Socket;
6946
6947    my $socket = IO::Socket::INET->new(
6948        Timeout  => '10',
6949        PeerAddr => $remoteport,
6950        Proto    => 'tcp',
6951    );
6952    if ( ! $socket ) {
6953        die "Unable to connect to remote host: $remoteport\n";
6954    }
6955    return $socket;
6956}
6957
6958sub socket_get_fork_TTY {
6959    $tty = $LINEINFO = $IN = $OUT = connect_remoteport();
6960
6961    # Do I need to worry about setting $term?
6962
6963    reset_IN_OUT( $IN, $OUT );
6964    return '';
6965}
6966
6967=head3 C<xterm_get_fork_TTY>
6968
6969This function provides the C<get_fork_TTY> function for X11. If a
6970program running under the debugger forks, a new <xterm> window is opened and
6971the subsidiary debugger is directed there.
6972
6973The C<open()> call is of particular note here. We have the new C<xterm>
6974we're spawning route file number 3 to STDOUT, and then execute the C<tty>
6975command (which prints the device name of the TTY we'll want to use for input
6976and output to STDOUT, then C<sleep> for a very long time, routing this output
6977to file number 3. This way we can simply read from the <XT> filehandle (which
6978is STDOUT from the I<commands> we ran) to get the TTY we want to use.
6979
6980Only works if C<xterm> is in your path and C<$ENV{DISPLAY}>, etc. are
6981properly set up.
6982
6983=cut
6984
6985sub xterm_get_fork_TTY {
6986    ( my $name = $0 ) =~ s,^.*[/\\],,s;
6987    open XT,
6988qq[3>&1 xterm -title "Daughter Perl debugger $pids $name" -e sh -c 'tty 1>&3;\
6989 sleep 10000000' |];
6990
6991    # Get the output from 'tty' and clean it up a little.
6992    my $tty = <XT>;
6993    chomp $tty;
6994
6995    $pidprompt = '';    # Shown anyway in titlebar
6996
6997    # We need $term defined or we can not switch to the newly created xterm
6998    if ($tty ne '' && !defined $term) {
6999        require Term::ReadLine;
7000        if ( !$rl ) {
7001            $term = Term::ReadLine::Stub->new( 'perldb', $IN, $OUT );
7002        }
7003        else {
7004            $term = Term::ReadLine->new( 'perldb', $IN, $OUT );
7005        }
7006    }
7007    # There's our new TTY.
7008    return $tty;
7009} ## end sub xterm_get_fork_TTY
7010
7011=head3 C<os2_get_fork_TTY>
7012
7013XXX It behooves an OS/2 expert to write the necessary documentation for this!
7014
7015=cut
7016
7017# This example function resets $IN, $OUT itself
7018my $c_pipe = 0;
7019sub os2_get_fork_TTY { # A simplification of the following (and works without):
7020    local $\  = '';
7021    ( my $name = $0 ) =~ s,^.*[/\\],,s;
7022    my %opt = ( title => "Daughter Perl debugger $pids $name",
7023        ($rl ? (read_by_key => 1) : ()) );
7024    require OS2::Process;
7025    my ($in, $out, $pid) = eval { OS2::Process::io_term(related => 0, %opt) }
7026      or return;
7027    $pidprompt = '';    # Shown anyway in titlebar
7028    reset_IN_OUT($in, $out);
7029    $tty = '*reset*';
7030    return '';          # Indicate that reset_IN_OUT is called
7031} ## end sub os2_get_fork_TTY
7032
7033=head3 C<macosx_get_fork_TTY>
7034
7035The Mac OS X version uses AppleScript to tell Terminal.app to create
7036a new window.
7037
7038=cut
7039
7040# Notes about Terminal.app's AppleScript support,
7041# (aka things that might break in future OS versions).
7042#
7043# The "do script" command doesn't return a reference to the new window
7044# it creates, but since it appears frontmost and windows are enumerated
7045# front to back, we can use "first window" === "window 1".
7046#
7047# Since "do script" is implemented by supplying the argument (plus a
7048# return character) as terminal input, there's a potential race condition
7049# where the debugger could beat the shell to reading the command.
7050# To prevent this, we wait for the screen to clear before proceeding.
7051#
7052# 10.3 and 10.4:
7053# There's no direct accessor for the tty device name, so we fiddle
7054# with the window title options until it says what we want.
7055#
7056# 10.5:
7057# There _is_ a direct accessor for the tty device name, _and_ there's
7058# a new possible component of the window title (the name of the settings
7059# set).  A separate version is needed.
7060
7061my @script_versions=
7062
7063    ([237, <<'__LEOPARD__'],
7064tell application "Terminal"
7065    do script "clear;exec sleep 100000"
7066    tell first tab of first window
7067        copy tty to thetty
7068        set custom title to "forked perl debugger"
7069        set title displays custom title to true
7070        repeat while (length of first paragraph of (get contents)) > 0
7071            delay 0.1
7072        end repeat
7073    end tell
7074end tell
7075thetty
7076__LEOPARD__
7077
7078     [100, <<'__JAGUAR_TIGER__'],
7079tell application "Terminal"
7080    do script "clear;exec sleep 100000"
7081    tell first window
7082        set title displays shell path to false
7083        set title displays window size to false
7084        set title displays file name to false
7085        set title displays device name to true
7086        set title displays custom title to true
7087        set custom title to ""
7088        copy "/dev/" & name to thetty
7089        set custom title to "forked perl debugger"
7090        repeat while (length of first paragraph of (get contents)) > 0
7091            delay 0.1
7092        end repeat
7093    end tell
7094end tell
7095thetty
7096__JAGUAR_TIGER__
7097
7098);
7099
7100sub macosx_get_fork_TTY
7101{
7102    my($version,$script,$pipe,$tty);
7103
7104    return unless $version=$ENV{TERM_PROGRAM_VERSION};
7105    foreach my $entry (@script_versions) {
7106        if ($version>=$entry->[0]) {
7107            $script=$entry->[1];
7108            last;
7109        }
7110    }
7111    return unless defined($script);
7112    return unless open($pipe,'-|','/usr/bin/osascript','-e',$script);
7113    $tty=readline($pipe);
7114    close($pipe);
7115    return unless defined($tty) && $tty =~ m(^/dev/);
7116    chomp $tty;
7117    return $tty;
7118}
7119
7120=head3 C<tmux_get_fork_TTY>
7121
7122Creates a split window for subprocesses when a process running under the
7123perl debugger in Tmux forks.
7124
7125=cut
7126
7127sub tmux_get_fork_TTY {
7128    return unless $ENV{TMUX};
7129
7130    my $pipe;
7131
7132    my $status = open $pipe, '-|', 'tmux', 'split-window',
7133        '-P', '-F', '#{pane_tty}', 'sleep 100000';
7134
7135    if ( !$status ) {
7136        return;
7137    }
7138
7139    my $tty = <$pipe>;
7140    close $pipe;
7141
7142    if ( $tty ) {
7143        chomp $tty;
7144
7145        if ( !defined $term ) {
7146            require Term::ReadLine;
7147            if ( !$rl ) {
7148                $term = Term::ReadLine::Stub->new( 'perldb', $IN, $OUT );
7149            }
7150            else {
7151                $term = Term::ReadLine->new( 'perldb', $IN, $OUT );
7152            }
7153        }
7154    }
7155
7156    return $tty;
7157}
7158
7159=head2 C<create_IN_OUT($flags)>
7160
7161Create a new pair of filehandles, pointing to a new TTY. If impossible,
7162try to diagnose why.
7163
7164Flags are:
7165
7166=over 4
7167
7168=item * 1 - Don't know how to create a new TTY.
7169
7170=item * 2 - Debugger has forked, but we can't get a new TTY.
7171
7172=item * 4 - standard debugger startup is happening.
7173
7174=back
7175
7176=cut
7177
7178use vars qw($fork_TTY);
7179
7180sub create_IN_OUT {    # Create a window with IN/OUT handles redirected there
7181
7182    # If we know how to get a new TTY, do it! $in will have
7183    # the TTY name if get_fork_TTY works.
7184    my $in = get_fork_TTY(@_) if defined &get_fork_TTY;
7185
7186    # It used to be that
7187    $in = $fork_TTY if defined $fork_TTY;    # Backward compatibility
7188
7189    if ( not defined $in ) {
7190        my $why = shift;
7191
7192        # We don't know how.
7193        print_help(<<EOP) if $why == 1;
7194I<#########> Forked, but do not know how to create a new B<TTY>. I<#########>
7195EOP
7196
7197        # Forked debugger.
7198        print_help(<<EOP) if $why == 2;
7199I<#########> Daughter session, do not know how to change a B<TTY>. I<#########>
7200  This may be an asynchronous session, so the parent debugger may be active.
7201EOP
7202
7203        # Note that both debuggers are fighting over the same input.
7204        print_help(<<EOP) if $why != 4;
7205  Since two debuggers fight for the same TTY, input is severely entangled.
7206
7207EOP
7208        print_help(<<EOP);
7209  I know how to switch the output to a different window in xterms, OS/2
7210  consoles, and Mac OS X Terminal.app only.  For a manual switch, put the name
7211  of the created I<TTY> in B<\$DB::fork_TTY>, or define a function
7212  B<DB::get_fork_TTY()> returning this.
7213
7214  On I<UNIX>-like systems one can get the name of a I<TTY> for the given window
7215  by typing B<tty>, and disconnect the I<shell> from I<TTY> by B<sleep 1000000>.
7216
7217EOP
7218    } ## end if (not defined $in)
7219    elsif ( $in ne '' ) {
7220        TTY($in);
7221    }
7222    else {
7223        $console = '';    # Indicate no need to open-from-the-console
7224    }
7225    undef $fork_TTY;
7226} ## end sub create_IN_OUT
7227
7228=head2 C<resetterm>
7229
7230Handles rejiggering the prompt when we've forked off a new debugger.
7231
7232If the new debugger happened because of a C<system()> that invoked a
7233program under the debugger, the arrow between the old pid and the new
7234in the prompt has I<two> dashes instead of one.
7235
7236We take the current list of pids and add this one to the end. If there
7237isn't any list yet, we make one up out of the initial pid associated with
7238the terminal and our new pid, sticking an arrow (either one-dashed or
7239two dashed) in between them.
7240
7241If C<CreateTTY> is off, or C<resetterm> was called with no arguments,
7242we don't try to create a new IN and OUT filehandle. Otherwise, we go ahead
7243and try to do that.
7244
7245=cut
7246
7247sub resetterm {    # We forked, so we need a different TTY
7248
7249    # Needs to be passed to create_IN_OUT() as well.
7250    my $in = shift;
7251
7252    # resetterm(2): got in here because of a system() starting a debugger.
7253    # resetterm(1): just forked.
7254    my $systemed = $in > 1 ? '-' : '';
7255
7256    # If there's already a list of pids, add this to the end.
7257    if ($pids) {
7258        $pids =~ s/\]/$systemed->$$]/;
7259    }
7260
7261    # No pid list. Time to make one.
7262    else {
7263        $pids = "[$term_pid->$$]";
7264    }
7265
7266    # The prompt we're going to be using for this debugger.
7267    $pidprompt = $pids;
7268
7269    # We now 0wnz this terminal.
7270    $term_pid = $$;
7271
7272    # Just return if we're not supposed to try to create a new TTY.
7273    return unless $CreateTTY & $in;
7274
7275    # Try to create a new IN/OUT pair.
7276    create_IN_OUT($in);
7277} ## end sub resetterm
7278
7279=head2 C<readline>
7280
7281First, we handle stuff in the typeahead buffer. If there is any, we shift off
7282the next line, print a message saying we got it, add it to the terminal
7283history (if possible), and return it.
7284
7285If there's nothing in the typeahead buffer, check the command filehandle stack.
7286If there are any filehandles there, read from the last one, and return the line
7287if we got one. If not, we pop the filehandle off and close it, and try the
7288next one up the stack.
7289
7290If we've emptied the filehandle stack, we check to see if we've got a socket
7291open, and we read that and return it if we do. If we don't, we just call the
7292core C<readline()> and return its value.
7293
7294=cut
7295
7296sub readline {
7297
7298    # Localize to prevent it from being smashed in the program being debugged.
7299    local $.;
7300
7301    # If there are stacked filehandles to read from ...
7302    # (Handle it before the typeahead, because we may call source/etc. from
7303    # the typeahead.)
7304    while (@cmdfhs) {
7305
7306        # Read from the last one in the stack.
7307        my $line = CORE::readline( $cmdfhs[-1] );
7308
7309        # If we got a line ...
7310        defined $line
7311          ? ( print $OUT ">> $line" and return $line )    # Echo and return
7312          : close pop @cmdfhs;                            # Pop and close
7313    } ## end while (@cmdfhs)
7314
7315    # Pull a line out of the typeahead if there's stuff there.
7316    if (@typeahead) {
7317
7318        # How many lines left.
7319        my $left = @typeahead;
7320
7321        # Get the next line.
7322        my $got = shift @typeahead;
7323
7324        # Print a message saying we got input from the typeahead.
7325        local $\ = '';
7326        print $OUT "auto(-$left)", shift, $got, "\n";
7327
7328        # Add it to the terminal history (if possible).
7329        $term->AddHistory($got)
7330          if length($got) > 1
7331          and defined $term->Features->{addHistory};
7332        return $got;
7333    } ## end if (@typeahead)
7334
7335    # We really need to read some input. Turn off entry/exit trace and
7336    # return value printing.
7337    local $frame = 0;
7338    local $doret = -2;
7339
7340    # Nothing on the filehandle stack. Socket?
7341    if ( ref $OUT and UNIVERSAL::isa( $OUT, 'IO::Socket::INET' ) ) {
7342
7343        # Send anything we have to send.
7344        $OUT->write( join( '', @_ ) );
7345
7346        # Receive anything there is to receive.
7347        my $stuff = '';
7348        my $buf;
7349        my $first_time = 1;
7350
7351        while ($first_time or (length($buf) && ($stuff .= $buf) !~ /\n/))
7352        {
7353            $first_time = 0;
7354            $IN->recv( $buf = '', 2048 );   # XXX "what's wrong with sysread?"
7355                                            # XXX Don't know. You tell me.
7356        }
7357
7358        # What we got.
7359        return $stuff;
7360    } ## end if (ref $OUT and UNIVERSAL::isa...
7361
7362    # No socket. Just read from the terminal.
7363    else {
7364        return $term->readline(@_);
7365    }
7366} ## end sub readline
7367
7368=head1 OPTIONS SUPPORT ROUTINES
7369
7370These routines handle listing and setting option values.
7371
7372=head2 C<dump_option> - list the current value of an option setting
7373
7374This routine uses C<option_val> to look up the value for an option.
7375It cleans up escaped single-quotes and then displays the option and
7376its value.
7377
7378=cut
7379
7380sub dump_option {
7381    my ( $opt, $val ) = @_;
7382    $val = option_val( $opt, 'N/A' );
7383    $val =~ s/([\\\'])/\\$1/g;
7384    printf $OUT "%20s = '%s'\n", $opt, $val;
7385} ## end sub dump_option
7386
7387sub options2remember {
7388    foreach my $k (@RememberOnROptions) {
7389        $option{$k} = option_val( $k, 'N/A' );
7390    }
7391    return %option;
7392}
7393
7394=head2 C<option_val> - find the current value of an option
7395
7396This can't just be a simple hash lookup because of the indirect way that
7397the option values are stored. Some are retrieved by calling a subroutine,
7398some are just variables.
7399
7400You must supply a default value to be used in case the option isn't set.
7401
7402=cut
7403
7404sub option_val {
7405    my ( $opt, $default ) = @_;
7406    my $val;
7407
7408    # Does this option exist, and is it a variable?
7409    # If so, retrieve the value via the value in %optionVars.
7410    if (    defined $optionVars{$opt}
7411        and defined ${ $optionVars{$opt} } )
7412    {
7413        $val = ${ $optionVars{$opt} };
7414    }
7415
7416    # Does this option exist, and it's a subroutine?
7417    # If so, call the subroutine via the ref in %optionAction
7418    # and capture the value.
7419    elsif ( defined $optionAction{$opt}
7420        and defined &{ $optionAction{$opt} } )
7421    {
7422        $val = &{ $optionAction{$opt} }();
7423    }
7424
7425    # If there's an action or variable for the supplied option,
7426    # but no value was set, use the default.
7427    elsif (defined $optionAction{$opt} and not defined $option{$opt}
7428        or defined $optionVars{$opt} and not defined ${ $optionVars{$opt} } )
7429    {
7430        $val = $default;
7431    }
7432
7433    # Otherwise, do the simple hash lookup.
7434    else {
7435        $val = $option{$opt};
7436    }
7437
7438    # If the value isn't defined, use the default.
7439    # Then return whatever the value is.
7440    $val = $default unless defined $val;
7441    $val;
7442} ## end sub option_val
7443
7444=head2 C<parse_options>
7445
7446Handles the parsing and execution of option setting/displaying commands.
7447
7448An option entered by itself is assumed to be I<set me to 1> (the default value)
7449if the option is a boolean one. If not, the user is prompted to enter a valid
7450value or to query the current value (via C<option? >).
7451
7452If C<option=value> is entered, we try to extract a quoted string from the
7453value (if it is quoted). If it's not, we just use the whole value as-is.
7454
7455We load any modules required to service this option, and then we set it: if
7456it just gets stuck in a variable, we do that; if there's a subroutine to
7457handle setting the option, we call that.
7458
7459Finally, if we're running in interactive mode, we display the effect of the
7460user's command back to the terminal, skipping this if we're setting things
7461during initialization.
7462
7463=cut
7464
7465sub parse_options {
7466    my ($s) = @_;
7467    local $\ = '';
7468
7469    my $option;
7470
7471    # These options need a value. Don't allow them to be clobbered by accident.
7472    my %opt_needs_val = map { ( $_ => 1 ) } qw{
7473      dumpDepth arrayDepth hashDepth LineInfo maxTraceLen ornaments windowSize
7474      pager quote ReadLine recallCommand RemotePort ShellBang TTY CommandSet
7475    };
7476
7477    while (length($s)) {
7478        my $val_defaulted;
7479
7480        # Clean off excess leading whitespace.
7481        $s =~ s/^\s+// && next;
7482
7483        # Options are always all word characters, followed by a non-word
7484        # separator.
7485        if ($s !~ s/^(\w+)(\W?)//) {
7486            print {$OUT} "Invalid option '$s'\n";
7487            last;
7488        }
7489        my ( $opt, $sep ) = ( $1, $2 );
7490
7491        # Make sure that such an option exists.
7492        my $matches = ( grep { /^\Q$opt/ && ( $option = $_ ) } @options )
7493          || ( grep { /^\Q$opt/i && ( $option = $_ ) } @options );
7494
7495        unless ($matches) {
7496            print {$OUT} "Unknown option '$opt'\n";
7497            next;
7498        }
7499        if ($matches > 1) {
7500            print {$OUT} "Ambiguous option '$opt'\n";
7501            next;
7502        }
7503        my $val;
7504
7505        # '?' as separator means query, but must have whitespace after it.
7506        if ( "?" eq $sep ) {
7507            if ($s =~ /\A\S/) {
7508                print {$OUT} "Option query '$opt?' followed by non-space '$s'\n" ;
7509
7510                last;
7511            }
7512
7513            #&dump_option($opt);
7514        } ## end if ("?" eq $sep)
7515
7516        # Separator is whitespace (or just a carriage return).
7517        # They're going for a default, which we assume is 1.
7518        elsif ( $sep !~ /\S/ ) {
7519            $val_defaulted = 1;
7520            $val           = "1";   #  this is an evil default; make 'em set it!
7521        }
7522
7523        # Separator is =. Trying to set a value.
7524        elsif ( $sep eq "=" ) {
7525
7526            # If quoted, extract a quoted string.
7527            if ($s =~ s/ (["']) ( (?: \\. | (?! \1 ) [^\\] )* ) \1 //x) {
7528                my $quote = $1;
7529                ( $val = $2 ) =~ s/\\([$quote\\])/$1/g;
7530            }
7531
7532            # Not quoted. Use the whole thing. Warn about 'option='.
7533            else {
7534                $s =~ s/^(\S*)//;
7535                $val = $1;
7536                print OUT qq(Option better cleared using $opt=""\n)
7537                  unless length $val;
7538            } ## end else [ if (s/ (["']) ( (?: \\. | (?! \1 ) [^\\] )* ) \1 //x)
7539
7540        } ## end elsif ($sep eq "=")
7541
7542        # "Quoted" with [], <>, or {}.
7543        else {    #{ to "let some poor schmuck bounce on the % key in B<vi>."
7544            my ($end) =
7545              "\\" . substr( ")]>}$sep", index( "([<{", $sep ), 1 );    #}
7546            $s =~ s/^(([^\\$end]|\\[\\$end])*)$end($|\s+)//
7547              or print( $OUT "Unclosed option value '$opt$sep$_'\n" ), last;
7548            ( $val = $1 ) =~ s/\\([\\$end])/$1/g;
7549        } ## end else [ if ("?" eq $sep)
7550
7551        # Exclude non-booleans from getting set to 1 by default.
7552        if ( $opt_needs_val{$option} && $val_defaulted ) {
7553            my $cmd = ( $CommandSet eq '580' ) ? 'o' : 'O';
7554            print {$OUT}
7555"Option '$opt' is non-boolean.  Use '$cmd $option=VAL' to set, '$cmd $option?' to query\n";
7556            next;
7557        } ## end if ($opt_needs_val{$option...
7558
7559        # Save the option value.
7560        $option{$option} = $val if defined $val;
7561
7562        # Load any module that this option requires.
7563        if ( defined($optionRequire{$option}) && defined($val) ) {
7564            eval qq{
7565            local \$frame = 0;
7566            local \$doret = -2;
7567            require '$optionRequire{$option}';
7568            1;
7569            } || die $@   # XXX: shouldn't happen
7570        }
7571
7572        # Set it.
7573        # Stick it in the proper variable if it goes in a variable.
7574        if (defined($optionVars{$option}) && defined($val)) {
7575            ${ $optionVars{$option} } = $val;
7576        }
7577
7578        # Call the appropriate sub if it gets set via sub.
7579        if (defined($optionAction{$option})
7580          && defined (&{ $optionAction{$option} })
7581          && defined ($val))
7582        {
7583          &{ $optionAction{$option} }($val);
7584        }
7585
7586        # Not initialization - echo the value we set it to.
7587        dump_option($option) if ($OUT ne \*STDERR);
7588    } ## end while (length)
7589} ## end sub parse_options
7590
7591=head1 RESTART SUPPORT
7592
7593These routines are used to store (and restore) lists of items in environment
7594variables during a restart.
7595
7596=head2 set_list
7597
7598Set_list packages up items to be stored in a set of environment variables
7599(VAR_n, containing the number of items, and VAR_0, VAR_1, etc., containing
7600the values). Values outside the standard ASCII charset are stored by encoding
7601them as hexadecimal values.
7602
7603=cut
7604
7605sub set_list {
7606    my ( $stem, @list ) = @_;
7607    my $val;
7608
7609    # VAR_n: how many we have. Scalar assignment gets the number of items.
7610    $ENV{"${stem}_n"} = @list;
7611
7612    # Grab each item in the list, escape the backslashes, encode the non-ASCII
7613    # as hex, and then save in the appropriate VAR_0, VAR_1, etc.
7614    for my $i ( 0 .. $#list ) {
7615        $val = $list[$i];
7616        $val =~ s/\\/\\\\/g;
7617        no warnings 'experimental::regex_sets';
7618        $val =~ s/ ( (?[ [\000-\xFF] & [:^print:] ]) ) /
7619                                                "\\0x" . unpack('H2',$1)/xaeg;
7620        $ENV{"${stem}_$i"} = $val;
7621    } ## end for $i (0 .. $#list)
7622} ## end sub set_list
7623
7624=head2 get_list
7625
7626Reverse the set_list operation: grab VAR_n to see how many we should be getting
7627back, and then pull VAR_0, VAR_1. etc. back out.
7628
7629=cut
7630
7631sub get_list {
7632    my $stem = shift;
7633    my @list;
7634    my $n = delete $ENV{"${stem}_n"};
7635    my $val;
7636    for my $i ( 0 .. $n - 1 ) {
7637        $val = delete $ENV{"${stem}_$i"};
7638        $val =~ s/\\((\\)|0x(..))/ $2 ? $2 : pack('H2', $3) /ge;
7639        push @list, $val;
7640    }
7641    @list;
7642} ## end sub get_list
7643
7644=head1 MISCELLANEOUS SIGNAL AND I/O MANAGEMENT
7645
7646=head2 catch()
7647
7648The C<catch()> subroutine is the essence of fast and low-impact. We simply
7649set an already-existing global scalar variable to a constant value. This
7650avoids allocating any memory possibly in the middle of something that will
7651get all confused if we do, particularly under I<unsafe signals>.
7652
7653=cut
7654
7655sub catch {
7656    $signal = 1;
7657    return;    # Put nothing on the stack - malloc/free land!
7658}
7659
7660=head2 C<warn()>
7661
7662C<warn> emits a warning, by joining together its arguments and printing
7663them, with couple of fillips.
7664
7665If the composited message I<doesn't> end with a newline, we automatically
7666add C<$!> and a newline to the end of the message. The subroutine expects $OUT
7667to be set to the filehandle to be used to output warnings; it makes no
7668assumptions about what filehandles are available.
7669
7670=cut
7671
7672sub _db_warn {
7673    my ($msg) = join( "", @_ );
7674    $msg .= ": $!\n" unless $msg =~ /\n$/;
7675    local $\ = '';
7676    print $OUT $msg;
7677} ## end sub warn
7678
7679*warn = \&_db_warn;
7680
7681=head1 INITIALIZATION TTY SUPPORT
7682
7683=head2 C<reset_IN_OUT>
7684
7685This routine handles restoring the debugger's input and output filehandles
7686after we've tried and failed to move them elsewhere.  In addition, it assigns
7687the debugger's output filehandle to $LINEINFO if it was already open there.
7688
7689=cut
7690
7691sub reset_IN_OUT {
7692    my $switch_li = $LINEINFO eq $OUT;
7693
7694    # If there's a term and it's able to get a new tty, try to get one.
7695    if ( $term and $term->Features->{newTTY} ) {
7696        ( $IN, $OUT ) = ( shift, shift );
7697        $term->newTTY( $IN, $OUT );
7698    }
7699
7700    # This term can't get a new tty now. Better luck later.
7701    elsif ($term) {
7702        _db_warn("Too late to set IN/OUT filehandles, enabled on next 'R'!\n");
7703    }
7704
7705    # Set the filehndles up as they were.
7706    else {
7707        ( $IN, $OUT ) = ( shift, shift );
7708    }
7709
7710    # Unbuffer the output filehandle.
7711    _autoflush($OUT);
7712
7713    # Point LINEINFO to the same output filehandle if it was there before.
7714    $LINEINFO = $OUT if $switch_li;
7715} ## end sub reset_IN_OUT
7716
7717=head1 OPTION SUPPORT ROUTINES
7718
7719The following routines are used to process some of the more complicated
7720debugger options.
7721
7722=head2 C<TTY>
7723
7724Sets the input and output filehandles to the specified files or pipes.
7725If the terminal supports switching, we go ahead and do it. If not, and
7726there's already a terminal in place, we save the information to take effect
7727on restart.
7728
7729If there's no terminal yet (for instance, during debugger initialization),
7730we go ahead and set C<$console> and C<$tty> to the file indicated.
7731
7732=cut
7733
7734sub TTY {
7735
7736    if ( @_ and $term and $term->Features->{newTTY} ) {
7737
7738        # This terminal supports switching to a new TTY.
7739        # Can be a list of two files, or on string containing both names,
7740        # comma-separated.
7741        # XXX Should this perhaps be an assignment from @_?
7742        my ( $in, $out ) = shift;
7743        if ( $in =~ /,/ ) {
7744
7745            # Split list apart if supplied.
7746            ( $in, $out ) = split /,/, $in, 2;
7747        }
7748        else {
7749
7750            # Use the same file for both input and output.
7751            $out = $in;
7752        }
7753
7754        # Open file onto the debugger's filehandles, if you can.
7755        open IN,  '<', $in or die "cannot open '$in' for read: $!";
7756        open OUT, '>', $out or die "cannot open '$out' for write: $!";
7757
7758        # Swap to the new filehandles.
7759        reset_IN_OUT( \*IN, \*OUT );
7760
7761        # Save the setting for later.
7762        return $tty = $in;
7763    } ## end if (@_ and $term and $term...
7764
7765    # Terminal doesn't support new TTY, or doesn't support readline.
7766    # Can't do it now, try restarting.
7767    if ($term and @_) {
7768        _db_warn("Too late to set TTY, enabled on next 'R'!\n");
7769    }
7770
7771    # Useful if done through PERLDB_OPTS:
7772    $console = $tty = shift if @_;
7773
7774    # Return whatever the TTY is.
7775    $tty or $console;
7776} ## end sub TTY
7777
7778=head2 C<noTTY>
7779
7780Sets the C<$notty> global, controlling whether or not the debugger tries to
7781get a terminal to read from. If called after a terminal is already in place,
7782we save the value to use it if we're restarted.
7783
7784=cut
7785
7786sub noTTY {
7787    if ($term) {
7788        _db_warn("Too late to set noTTY, enabled on next 'R'!\n") if @_;
7789    }
7790    $notty = shift if @_;
7791    $notty;
7792} ## end sub noTTY
7793
7794=head2 C<ReadLine>
7795
7796Sets the C<$rl> option variable. If 0, we use C<Term::ReadLine::Stub>
7797(essentially, no C<readline> processing on this I<terminal>). Otherwise, we
7798use C<Term::ReadLine>. Can't be changed after a terminal's in place; we save
7799the value in case a restart is done so we can change it then.
7800
7801=cut
7802
7803sub ReadLine {
7804    if ($term) {
7805        _db_warn("Too late to set ReadLine, enabled on next 'R'!\n") if @_;
7806    }
7807    $rl = shift if @_;
7808    $rl;
7809} ## end sub ReadLine
7810
7811=head2 C<RemotePort>
7812
7813Sets the port that the debugger will try to connect to when starting up.
7814If the terminal's already been set up, we can't do it, but we remember the
7815setting in case the user does a restart.
7816
7817=cut
7818
7819sub RemotePort {
7820    if ($term) {
7821        _db_warn("Too late to set RemotePort, enabled on next 'R'!\n") if @_;
7822    }
7823    $remoteport = shift if @_;
7824    $remoteport;
7825} ## end sub RemotePort
7826
7827=head2 C<tkRunning>
7828
7829Checks with the terminal to see if C<Tk> is running, and returns true or
7830false. Returns false if the current terminal doesn't support C<readline>.
7831
7832=cut
7833
7834sub tkRunning {
7835    if ( ${ $term->Features }{tkRunning} ) {
7836        return $term->tkRunning(@_);
7837    }
7838    else {
7839        local $\ = '';
7840        print $OUT "tkRunning not supported by current ReadLine package.\n";
7841        0;
7842    }
7843} ## end sub tkRunning
7844
7845=head2 C<NonStop>
7846
7847Sets nonstop mode. If a terminal's already been set up, it's too late; the
7848debugger remembers the setting in case you restart, though.
7849
7850=cut
7851
7852sub NonStop {
7853    if ($term) {
7854        _db_warn("Too late to set up NonStop mode, enabled on next 'R'!\n")
7855          if @_;
7856    }
7857    $runnonstop = shift if @_;
7858    $runnonstop;
7859} ## end sub NonStop
7860
7861sub DollarCaretP {
7862    if ($term) {
7863        _db_warn("Some flag changes could not take effect until next 'R'!\n")
7864          if @_;
7865    }
7866    $^P = parse_DollarCaretP_flags(shift) if @_;
7867    expand_DollarCaretP_flags($^P);
7868}
7869
7870=head2 C<pager>
7871
7872Set up the C<$pager> variable. Adds a pipe to the front unless there's one
7873there already.
7874
7875=cut
7876
7877sub pager {
7878    if (@_) {
7879        $pager = shift;
7880        $pager = "|" . $pager unless $pager =~ /^(\+?\>|\|)/;
7881    }
7882    $pager;
7883} ## end sub pager
7884
7885=head2 C<shellBang>
7886
7887Sets the shell escape command, and generates a printable copy to be used
7888in the help.
7889
7890=cut
7891
7892sub shellBang {
7893
7894    # If we got an argument, meta-quote it, and add '\b' if it
7895    # ends in a word character.
7896    if (@_) {
7897        $sh = quotemeta shift;
7898        $sh .= "\\b" if $sh =~ /\w$/;
7899    }
7900
7901    # Generate the printable version for the help:
7902    $psh = $sh;    # copy it
7903    $psh =~ s/\\b$//;        # Take off trailing \b if any
7904    $psh =~ s/\\(.)/$1/g;    # De-escape
7905    $psh;                    # return the printable version
7906} ## end sub shellBang
7907
7908=head2 C<ornaments>
7909
7910If the terminal has its own ornaments, fetch them. Otherwise accept whatever
7911was passed as the argument. (This means you can't override the terminal's
7912ornaments.)
7913
7914=cut
7915
7916sub ornaments {
7917    if ( defined $term ) {
7918
7919        # We don't want to show warning backtraces, but we do want die() ones.
7920        local $warnLevel = 0;
7921        local $dieLevel = 1;
7922
7923        # No ornaments if the terminal doesn't support them.
7924        if (not $term->Features->{ornaments}) {
7925            return '';
7926        }
7927
7928        return (eval { $term->ornaments(@_) } || '');
7929    }
7930
7931    # Use what was passed in if we can't determine it ourselves.
7932    else {
7933        $ornaments = shift;
7934
7935        return $ornaments;
7936    }
7937
7938} ## end sub ornaments
7939
7940=head2 C<recallCommand>
7941
7942Sets the recall command, and builds a printable version which will appear in
7943the help text.
7944
7945=cut
7946
7947sub recallCommand {
7948
7949    # If there is input, metaquote it. Add '\b' if it ends with a word
7950    # character.
7951    if (@_) {
7952        $rc = quotemeta shift;
7953        $rc .= "\\b" if $rc =~ /\w$/;
7954    }
7955
7956    # Build it into a printable version.
7957    $prc = $rc;              # Copy it
7958    $prc =~ s/\\b$//;        # Remove trailing \b
7959    $prc =~ s/\\(.)/$1/g;    # Remove escapes
7960    return $prc;             # Return the printable version
7961} ## end sub recallCommand
7962
7963=head2 C<LineInfo> - where the line number information goes
7964
7965Called with no arguments, returns the file or pipe that line info should go to.
7966
7967Called with an argument (a file or a pipe), it opens that onto the
7968C<LINEINFO> filehandle, unbuffers the filehandle, and then returns the
7969file or pipe again to the caller.
7970
7971=cut
7972
7973sub LineInfo {
7974    if (@_) {
7975        $lineinfo = shift;
7976
7977        #  If this is a valid "thing to be opened for output", tack a
7978        # '>' onto the front.
7979        my $stream = ( $lineinfo =~ /^(\+?\>|\|)/ ) ? $lineinfo : ">$lineinfo";
7980
7981        # If this is a pipe, the stream points to a slave editor.
7982        $slave_editor = ( $stream =~ /^\|/ );
7983
7984        my $new_lineinfo_fh;
7985        # Open it up and unbuffer it.
7986        open ($new_lineinfo_fh , $stream )
7987            or _db_warn("Cannot open '$stream' for write");
7988        $LINEINFO = $new_lineinfo_fh;
7989        _autoflush($LINEINFO);
7990    }
7991
7992    return $lineinfo;
7993} ## end sub LineInfo
7994
7995=head1 COMMAND SUPPORT ROUTINES
7996
7997These subroutines provide functionality for various commands.
7998
7999=head2 C<list_modules>
8000
8001For the C<M> command: list modules loaded and their versions.
8002Essentially just runs through the keys in %INC, picks each package's
8003C<$VERSION> variable, gets the file name, and formats the information
8004for output.
8005
8006=cut
8007
8008sub list_modules {    # versions
8009    my %version;
8010    my $file;
8011
8012    # keys are the "as-loaded" name, values are the fully-qualified path
8013    # to the file itself.
8014    for ( keys %INC ) {
8015        $file = $_;                                # get the module name
8016        s,\.p[lm]$,,i;                             # remove '.pl' or '.pm'
8017        s,/,::,g;                                  # change '/' to '::'
8018        s/^perl5db$/DB/;                           # Special case: debugger
8019                                                   # moves to package DB
8020        s/^Term::ReadLine::readline$/readline/;    # simplify readline
8021
8022        # If the package has a $VERSION package global (as all good packages
8023        # should!) decode it and save as partial message.
8024        my $pkg_version = do { no strict 'refs'; ${ $_ . '::VERSION' } };
8025        if ( defined $pkg_version ) {
8026            $version{$file} = "$pkg_version from ";
8027        }
8028
8029        # Finish up the message with the file the package came from.
8030        $version{$file} .= $INC{$file};
8031    } ## end for (keys %INC)
8032
8033    # Hey, dumpit() formats a hash nicely, so why not use it?
8034    dumpit( $OUT, \%version );
8035} ## end sub list_modules
8036
8037=head2 C<sethelp()>
8038
8039Sets up the monster string used to format and print the help.
8040
8041=head3 HELP MESSAGE FORMAT
8042
8043The help message is a peculiar format unto itself; it mixes C<pod> I<ornaments>
8044(C<< B<> >> C<< I<> >>) with tabs to come up with a format that's fairly
8045easy to parse and portable, but which still allows the help to be a little
8046nicer than just plain text.
8047
8048Essentially, you define the command name (usually marked up with C<< B<> >>
8049and C<< I<> >>), followed by a tab, and then the descriptive text, ending in a
8050newline. The descriptive text can also be marked up in the same way. If you
8051need to continue the descriptive text to another line, start that line with
8052just tabs and then enter the marked-up text.
8053
8054If you are modifying the help text, I<be careful>. The help-string parser is
8055not very sophisticated, and if you don't follow these rules it will mangle the
8056help beyond hope until you fix the string.
8057
8058=cut
8059
8060use vars qw($pre580_help);
8061use vars qw($pre580_summary);
8062
8063sub sethelp {
8064
8065    # XXX: make sure there are tabs between the command and explanation,
8066    #      or print_help will screw up your formatting if you have
8067    #      eeevil ornaments enabled.  This is an insane mess.
8068
8069    $help = "
8070Help is currently only available for the new 5.8 command set.
8071No help is available for the old command set.
8072We assume you know what you're doing if you switch to it.
8073
8074B<T>        Stack trace.
8075B<s> [I<expr>]    Single step [in I<expr>].
8076B<n> [I<expr>]    Next, steps over subroutine calls [in I<expr>].
8077<B<CR>>        Repeat last B<n> or B<s> command.
8078B<r>        Return from current subroutine.
8079B<c> [I<line>|I<sub>]    Continue; optionally inserts a one-time-only breakpoint
8080        at the specified position.
8081B<l> I<min>B<+>I<incr>    List I<incr>+1 lines starting at I<min>.
8082B<l> I<min>B<->I<max>    List lines I<min> through I<max>.
8083B<l> I<line>        List single I<line>.
8084B<l> I<subname>    List first window of lines from subroutine.
8085B<l> I<\$var>        List first window of lines from subroutine referenced by I<\$var>.
8086B<l>        List next window of lines.
8087B<->        List previous window of lines.
8088B<v> [I<line>]    View window around I<line>.
8089B<.>        Return to the executed line.
8090B<f> I<filename>    Switch to viewing I<filename>. File must be already loaded.
8091        I<filename> may be either the full name of the file, or a regular
8092        expression matching the full file name:
8093        B<f> I</home/me/foo.pl> and B<f> I<oo\\.> may access the same file.
8094        Evals (with saved bodies) are considered to be filenames:
8095        B<f> I<(eval 7)> and B<f> I<eval 7\\b> access the body of the 7th eval
8096        (in the order of execution).
8097B</>I<pattern>B</>    Search forwards for I<pattern>; final B</> is optional.
8098B<?>I<pattern>B<?>    Search backwards for I<pattern>; final B<?> is optional.
8099B<L> [I<a|b|w>]        List actions and or breakpoints and or watch-expressions.
8100B<S> [[B<!>]I<pattern>]    List subroutine names [not] matching I<pattern>.
8101B<t> [I<n>]       Toggle trace mode (to max I<n> levels below current stack depth).
8102B<t> [I<n>] I<expr>        Trace through execution of I<expr>.
8103B<b>        Sets breakpoint on current line)
8104B<b> [I<line>] [I<condition>]
8105        Set breakpoint; I<line> defaults to the current execution line;
8106        I<condition> breaks if it evaluates to true, defaults to '1'.
8107B<b> I<subname> [I<condition>]
8108        Set breakpoint at first line of subroutine.
8109B<b> I<\$var>        Set breakpoint at first line of subroutine referenced by I<\$var>.
8110B<b> B<load> I<filename> Set breakpoint on 'require'ing the given file.
8111B<b> B<postpone> I<subname> [I<condition>]
8112        Set breakpoint at first line of subroutine after
8113        it is compiled.
8114B<b> B<compile> I<subname>
8115        Stop after the subroutine is compiled.
8116B<B> [I<line>]    Delete the breakpoint for I<line>.
8117B<B> I<*>             Delete all breakpoints.
8118B<a> [I<line>] I<command>
8119        Set an action to be done before the I<line> is executed;
8120        I<line> defaults to the current execution line.
8121        Sequence is: check for breakpoint/watchpoint, print line
8122        if necessary, do action, prompt user if necessary,
8123        execute line.
8124B<a>        Does nothing
8125B<A> [I<line>]    Delete the action for I<line>.
8126B<A> I<*>             Delete all actions.
8127B<w> I<expr>        Add a global watch-expression.
8128B<w>             Does nothing
8129B<W> I<expr>        Delete a global watch-expression.
8130B<W> I<*>             Delete all watch-expressions.
8131B<V> [I<pkg> [I<vars>]]    List some (default all) variables in package (default current).
8132        Use B<~>I<pattern> and B<!>I<pattern> for positive and negative regexps.
8133B<X> [I<vars>]    Same as \"B<V> I<currentpackage> [I<vars>]\".
8134B<x> I<expr>        Evals expression in list context, dumps the result.
8135B<m> I<expr>        Evals expression in list context, prints methods callable
8136        on the first element of the result.
8137B<m> I<class>        Prints methods callable via the given class.
8138B<M>        Show versions of loaded modules.
8139B<i> I<class>       Prints nested parents of given class.
8140B<e>         Display current thread id.
8141B<E>         Display all thread ids the current one will be identified: <n>.
8142B<y> [I<n> [I<Vars>]]   List lexicals in higher scope <n>.  Vars same as B<V>.
8143
8144B<<> ?            List Perl commands to run before each prompt.
8145B<<> I<expr>        Define Perl command to run before each prompt.
8146B<<<> I<expr>        Add to the list of Perl commands to run before each prompt.
8147B<< *>                Delete the list of perl commands to run before each prompt.
8148B<>> ?            List Perl commands to run after each prompt.
8149B<>> I<expr>        Define Perl command to run after each prompt.
8150B<>>B<>> I<expr>        Add to the list of Perl commands to run after each prompt.
8151B<>>B< *>        Delete the list of Perl commands to run after each prompt.
8152B<{> I<db_command>    Define debugger command to run before each prompt.
8153B<{> ?            List debugger commands to run before each prompt.
8154B<{{> I<db_command>    Add to the list of debugger commands to run before each prompt.
8155B<{ *>             Delete the list of debugger commands to run before each prompt.
8156B<$prc> I<number>    Redo a previous command (default previous command).
8157B<$prc> I<-number>    Redo number'th-to-last command.
8158B<$prc> I<pattern>    Redo last command that started with I<pattern>.
8159        See 'B<O> I<recallCommand>' too.
8160B<$psh$psh> I<cmd>      Run cmd in a subprocess (reads from DB::IN, writes to DB::OUT)"
8161      . (
8162        $rc eq $sh
8163        ? ""
8164        : "
8165B<$psh> [I<cmd>] Run I<cmd> in subshell (forces \"\$SHELL -c 'cmd'\")."
8166      ) . "
8167        See 'B<O> I<shellBang>' too.
8168B<source> I<file>     Execute I<file> containing debugger commands (may nest).
8169B<save> I<file>       Save current debugger session (actual history) to I<file>.
8170B<rerun>           Rerun session to current position.
8171B<rerun> I<n>         Rerun session to numbered command.
8172B<rerun> I<-n>        Rerun session to number'th-to-last command.
8173B<H> I<-number>    Display last number commands (default all).
8174B<H> I<*>          Delete complete history.
8175B<p> I<expr>        Same as \"I<print {DB::OUT} expr>\" in current package.
8176B<|>I<dbcmd>        Run debugger command, piping DB::OUT to current pager.
8177B<||>I<dbcmd>        Same as B<|>I<dbcmd> but DB::OUT is temporarily select()ed as well.
8178B<\=> [I<alias> I<value>]    Define a command alias, or list current aliases.
8179I<command>        Execute as a perl statement in current package.
8180B<R>        Pure-man-restart of debugger, some of debugger state
8181        and command-line options may be lost.
8182        Currently the following settings are preserved:
8183        history, breakpoints and actions, debugger B<O>ptions
8184        and the following command-line options: I<-w>, I<-I>, I<-e>.
8185
8186B<o> [I<opt>] ...    Set boolean option to true
8187B<o> [I<opt>B<?>]    Query options
8188B<o> [I<opt>B<=>I<val>] [I<opt>=B<\">I<val>B<\">] ...
8189        Set options.  Use quotes if spaces in value.
8190    I<recallCommand>, I<ShellBang>    chars used to recall command or spawn shell;
8191    I<pager>            program for output of \"|cmd\";
8192    I<tkRunning>            run Tk while prompting (with ReadLine);
8193    I<signalLevel> I<warnLevel> I<dieLevel>    level of verbosity;
8194    I<inhibit_exit>        Allows stepping off the end of the script.
8195    I<ImmediateStop>        Debugger should stop as early as possible.
8196    I<RemotePort>            Remote hostname:port for remote debugging
8197  The following options affect what happens with B<V>, B<X>, and B<x> commands:
8198    I<arrayDepth>, I<hashDepth>     print only first N elements ('' for all);
8199    I<compactDump>, I<veryCompact>     change style of array and hash dump;
8200    I<globPrint>             whether to print contents of globs;
8201    I<DumpDBFiles>         dump arrays holding debugged files;
8202    I<DumpPackages>         dump symbol tables of packages;
8203    I<DumpReused>             dump contents of \"reused\" addresses;
8204    I<quote>, I<HighBit>, I<undefPrint>     change style of string dump;
8205    I<bareStringify>         Do not print the overload-stringified value;
8206  Other options include:
8207    I<PrintRet>        affects printing of return value after B<r> command,
8208    I<frame>        affects printing messages on subroutine entry/exit.
8209    I<AutoTrace>    affects printing messages on possible breaking points.
8210    I<maxTraceLen>    gives max length of evals/args listed in stack trace.
8211    I<ornaments>     affects screen appearance of the command line.
8212    I<CreateTTY>     bits control attempts to create a new TTY on events:
8213            1: on fork()    2: debugger is started inside debugger
8214            4: on startup
8215    During startup options are initialized from \$ENV{PERLDB_OPTS}.
8216    You can put additional initialization options I<TTY>, I<noTTY>,
8217    I<ReadLine>, I<NonStop>, and I<RemotePort> there (or use
8218    B<R> after you set them).
8219
8220B<q> or B<^D>        Quit. Set B<\$DB::finished = 0> to debug global destruction.
8221B<h>        Summary of debugger commands.
8222B<h> [I<db_command>]    Get help [on a specific debugger command], enter B<|h> to page.
8223B<h h>        Long help for debugger commands
8224B<$doccmd> I<manpage>    Runs the external doc viewer B<$doccmd> command on the
8225        named Perl I<manpage>, or on B<$doccmd> itself if omitted.
8226        Set B<\$DB::doccmd> to change viewer.
8227
8228Type '|h h' for a paged display if this was too hard to read.
8229
8230";    # Fix balance of vi % matching: }}}}
8231
8232    #  note: tabs in the following section are not-so-helpful
8233    $summary = <<"END_SUM";
8234I<List/search source lines:>               I<Control script execution:>
8235  B<l> [I<ln>|I<sub>]  List source code            B<T>           Stack trace
8236  B<-> or B<.>      List previous/current line  B<s> [I<expr>]    Single step [in expr]
8237  B<v> [I<line>]    View around line            B<n> [I<expr>]    Next, steps over subs
8238  B<f> I<filename>  View source in file         <B<CR>/B<Enter>>  Repeat last B<n> or B<s>
8239  B</>I<pattern>B</> B<?>I<patt>B<?>   Search forw/backw    B<r>           Return from subroutine
8240  B<M>           Show module versions        B<c> [I<ln>|I<sub>]  Continue until position
8241I<Debugger controls:>                        B<L>           List break/watch/actions
8242  B<o> [...]     Set debugger options        B<t> [I<n>] [I<expr>] Toggle trace [max depth] ][trace expr]
8243  B<<>[B<<>]|B<{>[B<{>]|B<>>[B<>>] [I<cmd>] Do pre/post-prompt B<b> [I<ln>|I<event>|I<sub>] [I<cnd>] Set breakpoint
8244  B<$prc> [I<N>|I<pat>]   Redo a previous command     B<B> I<ln|*>      Delete a/all breakpoints
8245  B<H> [I<-num>]    Display last num commands   B<a> [I<ln>] I<cmd>  Do cmd before line
8246  B<=> [I<a> I<val>]   Define/list an alias        B<A> I<ln|*>      Delete a/all actions
8247  B<h> [I<db_cmd>]  Get help on command         B<w> I<expr>      Add a watch expression
8248  B<h h>         Complete help page          B<W> I<expr|*>    Delete a/all watch exprs
8249  B<|>[B<|>]I<db_cmd>  Send output to pager        B<$psh>\[B<$psh>\] I<syscmd> Run cmd in a subprocess
8250  B<q> or B<^D>     Quit                        B<R>           Attempt a restart
8251I<Data Examination:>     B<expr>     Execute perl code, also see: B<s>,B<n>,B<t> I<expr>
8252  B<x>|B<m> I<expr>       Evals expr in list context, dumps the result or lists methods.
8253  B<p> I<expr>         Print expression (uses script's current package).
8254  B<S> [[B<!>]I<pat>]     List subroutine names [not] matching pattern
8255  B<V> [I<Pk> [I<Vars>]]  List Variables in Package.  Vars can be ~pattern or !pattern.
8256  B<X> [I<Vars>]       Same as \"B<V> I<current_package> [I<Vars>]\".  B<i> I<class> inheritance tree.
8257  B<y> [I<n> [I<Vars>]]   List lexicals in higher scope <n>.  Vars same as B<V>.
8258  B<e>     Display thread id     B<E> Display all thread ids.
8259For more help, type B<h> I<cmd_letter>, or run B<$doccmd perldebug> for all docs.
8260END_SUM
8261
8262    # ')}}; # Fix balance of vi % matching
8263
8264    # and this is really numb...
8265    $pre580_help = "
8266B<T>        Stack trace.
8267B<s> [I<expr>]    Single step [in I<expr>].
8268B<n> [I<expr>]    Next, steps over subroutine calls [in I<expr>].
8269B<CR>>        Repeat last B<n> or B<s> command.
8270B<r>        Return from current subroutine.
8271B<c> [I<line>|I<sub>]    Continue; optionally inserts a one-time-only breakpoint
8272        at the specified position.
8273B<l> I<min>B<+>I<incr>    List I<incr>+1 lines starting at I<min>.
8274B<l> I<min>B<->I<max>    List lines I<min> through I<max>.
8275B<l> I<line>        List single I<line>.
8276B<l> I<subname>    List first window of lines from subroutine.
8277B<l> I<\$var>        List first window of lines from subroutine referenced by I<\$var>.
8278B<l>        List next window of lines.
8279B<->        List previous window of lines.
8280B<w> [I<line>]    List window around I<line>.
8281B<.>        Return to the executed line.
8282B<f> I<filename>    Switch to viewing I<filename>. File must be already loaded.
8283        I<filename> may be either the full name of the file, or a regular
8284        expression matching the full file name:
8285        B<f> I</home/me/foo.pl> and B<f> I<oo\\.> may access the same file.
8286        Evals (with saved bodies) are considered to be filenames:
8287        B<f> I<(eval 7)> and B<f> I<eval 7\\b> access the body of the 7th eval
8288        (in the order of execution).
8289B</>I<pattern>B</>    Search forwards for I<pattern>; final B</> is optional.
8290B<?>I<pattern>B<?>    Search backwards for I<pattern>; final B<?> is optional.
8291B<L>        List all breakpoints and actions.
8292B<S> [[B<!>]I<pattern>]    List subroutine names [not] matching I<pattern>.
8293B<t> [I<n>]       Toggle trace mode (to max I<n> levels below current stack depth) .
8294B<t> [I<n>] I<expr>        Trace through execution of I<expr>.
8295B<b> [I<line>] [I<condition>]
8296        Set breakpoint; I<line> defaults to the current execution line;
8297        I<condition> breaks if it evaluates to true, defaults to '1'.
8298B<b> I<subname> [I<condition>]
8299        Set breakpoint at first line of subroutine.
8300B<b> I<\$var>        Set breakpoint at first line of subroutine referenced by I<\$var>.
8301B<b> B<load> I<filename> Set breakpoint on 'require'ing the given file.
8302B<b> B<postpone> I<subname> [I<condition>]
8303        Set breakpoint at first line of subroutine after
8304        it is compiled.
8305B<b> B<compile> I<subname>
8306        Stop after the subroutine is compiled.
8307B<d> [I<line>]    Delete the breakpoint for I<line>.
8308B<D>        Delete all breakpoints.
8309B<a> [I<line>] I<command>
8310        Set an action to be done before the I<line> is executed;
8311        I<line> defaults to the current execution line.
8312        Sequence is: check for breakpoint/watchpoint, print line
8313        if necessary, do action, prompt user if necessary,
8314        execute line.
8315B<a> [I<line>]    Delete the action for I<line>.
8316B<A>        Delete all actions.
8317B<W> I<expr>        Add a global watch-expression.
8318B<W>        Delete all watch-expressions.
8319B<V> [I<pkg> [I<vars>]]    List some (default all) variables in package (default current).
8320        Use B<~>I<pattern> and B<!>I<pattern> for positive and negative regexps.
8321B<X> [I<vars>]    Same as \"B<V> I<currentpackage> [I<vars>]\".
8322B<x> I<expr>        Evals expression in list context, dumps the result.
8323B<m> I<expr>        Evals expression in list context, prints methods callable
8324        on the first element of the result.
8325B<m> I<class>        Prints methods callable via the given class.
8326
8327B<<> ?            List Perl commands to run before each prompt.
8328B<<> I<expr>        Define Perl command to run before each prompt.
8329B<<<> I<expr>        Add to the list of Perl commands to run before each prompt.
8330B<>> ?            List Perl commands to run after each prompt.
8331B<>> I<expr>        Define Perl command to run after each prompt.
8332B<>>B<>> I<expr>        Add to the list of Perl commands to run after each prompt.
8333B<{> I<db_command>    Define debugger command to run before each prompt.
8334B<{> ?            List debugger commands to run before each prompt.
8335B<{{> I<db_command>    Add to the list of debugger commands to run before each prompt.
8336B<$prc> I<number>    Redo a previous command (default previous command).
8337B<$prc> I<-number>    Redo number'th-to-last command.
8338B<$prc> I<pattern>    Redo last command that started with I<pattern>.
8339        See 'B<O> I<recallCommand>' too.
8340B<$psh$psh> I<cmd>      Run cmd in a subprocess (reads from DB::IN, writes to DB::OUT)"
8341      . (
8342        $rc eq $sh
8343        ? ""
8344        : "
8345B<$psh> [I<cmd>]     Run I<cmd> in subshell (forces \"\$SHELL -c 'cmd'\")."
8346      ) . "
8347        See 'B<O> I<shellBang>' too.
8348B<source> I<file>        Execute I<file> containing debugger commands (may nest).
8349B<H> I<-number>    Display last number commands (default all).
8350B<p> I<expr>        Same as \"I<print {DB::OUT} expr>\" in current package.
8351B<|>I<dbcmd>        Run debugger command, piping DB::OUT to current pager.
8352B<||>I<dbcmd>        Same as B<|>I<dbcmd> but DB::OUT is temporarilly select()ed as well.
8353B<\=> [I<alias> I<value>]    Define a command alias, or list current aliases.
8354I<command>        Execute as a perl statement in current package.
8355B<v>        Show versions of loaded modules.
8356B<R>        Pure-man-restart of debugger, some of debugger state
8357        and command-line options may be lost.
8358        Currently the following settings are preserved:
8359        history, breakpoints and actions, debugger B<O>ptions
8360        and the following command-line options: I<-w>, I<-I>, I<-e>.
8361
8362B<O> [I<opt>] ...    Set boolean option to true
8363B<O> [I<opt>B<?>]    Query options
8364B<O> [I<opt>B<=>I<val>] [I<opt>=B<\">I<val>B<\">] ...
8365        Set options.  Use quotes if spaces in value.
8366    I<recallCommand>, I<ShellBang>    chars used to recall command or spawn shell;
8367    I<pager>            program for output of \"|cmd\";
8368    I<tkRunning>            run Tk while prompting (with ReadLine);
8369    I<signalLevel> I<warnLevel> I<dieLevel>    level of verbosity;
8370    I<inhibit_exit>        Allows stepping off the end of the script.
8371    I<ImmediateStop>        Debugger should stop as early as possible.
8372    I<RemotePort>            Remote hostname:port for remote debugging
8373  The following options affect what happens with B<V>, B<X>, and B<x> commands:
8374    I<arrayDepth>, I<hashDepth>     print only first N elements ('' for all);
8375    I<compactDump>, I<veryCompact>     change style of array and hash dump;
8376    I<globPrint>             whether to print contents of globs;
8377    I<DumpDBFiles>         dump arrays holding debugged files;
8378    I<DumpPackages>         dump symbol tables of packages;
8379    I<DumpReused>             dump contents of \"reused\" addresses;
8380    I<quote>, I<HighBit>, I<undefPrint>     change style of string dump;
8381    I<bareStringify>         Do not print the overload-stringified value;
8382  Other options include:
8383    I<PrintRet>        affects printing of return value after B<r> command,
8384    I<frame>        affects printing messages on subroutine entry/exit.
8385    I<AutoTrace>    affects printing messages on possible breaking points.
8386    I<maxTraceLen>    gives max length of evals/args listed in stack trace.
8387    I<ornaments>     affects screen appearance of the command line.
8388    I<CreateTTY>     bits control attempts to create a new TTY on events:
8389            1: on fork()    2: debugger is started inside debugger
8390            4: on startup
8391    During startup options are initialized from \$ENV{PERLDB_OPTS}.
8392    You can put additional initialization options I<TTY>, I<noTTY>,
8393    I<ReadLine>, I<NonStop>, and I<RemotePort> there (or use
8394    B<R> after you set them).
8395
8396B<q> or B<^D>        Quit. Set B<\$DB::finished = 0> to debug global destruction.
8397B<h> [I<db_command>]    Get help [on a specific debugger command], enter B<|h> to page.
8398B<h h>        Summary of debugger commands.
8399B<$doccmd> I<manpage>    Runs the external doc viewer B<$doccmd> command on the
8400        named Perl I<manpage>, or on B<$doccmd> itself if omitted.
8401        Set B<\$DB::doccmd> to change viewer.
8402
8403Type '|h' for a paged display if this was too hard to read.
8404
8405";    # Fix balance of vi % matching: }}}}
8406
8407    #  note: tabs in the following section are not-so-helpful
8408    $pre580_summary = <<"END_SUM";
8409I<List/search source lines:>               I<Control script execution:>
8410  B<l> [I<ln>|I<sub>]  List source code            B<T>           Stack trace
8411  B<-> or B<.>      List previous/current line  B<s> [I<expr>]    Single step [in expr]
8412  B<w> [I<line>]    List around line            B<n> [I<expr>]    Next, steps over subs
8413  B<f> I<filename>  View source in file         <B<CR>/B<Enter>>  Repeat last B<n> or B<s>
8414  B</>I<pattern>B</> B<?>I<patt>B<?>   Search forw/backw    B<r>           Return from subroutine
8415  B<v>           Show versions of modules    B<c> [I<ln>|I<sub>]  Continue until position
8416I<Debugger controls:>                        B<L>           List break/watch/actions
8417  B<O> [...]     Set debugger options        B<t> [I<expr>]    Toggle trace [trace expr]
8418  B<<>[B<<>]|B<{>[B<{>]|B<>>[B<>>] [I<cmd>] Do pre/post-prompt B<b> [I<ln>|I<event>|I<sub>] [I<cnd>] Set breakpoint
8419  B<$prc> [I<N>|I<pat>]   Redo a previous command     B<d> [I<ln>] or B<D> Delete a/all breakpoints
8420  B<H> [I<-num>]    Display last num commands   B<a> [I<ln>] I<cmd>  Do cmd before line
8421  B<=> [I<a> I<val>]   Define/list an alias        B<W> I<expr>      Add a watch expression
8422  B<h> [I<db_cmd>]  Get help on command         B<A> or B<W>      Delete all actions/watch
8423  B<|>[B<|>]I<db_cmd>  Send output to pager        B<$psh>\[B<$psh>\] I<syscmd> Run cmd in a subprocess
8424  B<q> or B<^D>     Quit                        B<R>           Attempt a restart
8425I<Data Examination:>     B<expr>     Execute perl code, also see: B<s>,B<n>,B<t> I<expr>
8426  B<x>|B<m> I<expr>       Evals expr in list context, dumps the result or lists methods.
8427  B<p> I<expr>         Print expression (uses script's current package).
8428  B<S> [[B<!>]I<pat>]     List subroutine names [not] matching pattern
8429  B<V> [I<Pk> [I<Vars>]]  List Variables in Package.  Vars can be ~pattern or !pattern.
8430  B<X> [I<Vars>]       Same as \"B<V> I<current_package> [I<Vars>]\".
8431  B<y> [I<n> [I<Vars>]]   List lexicals in higher scope <n>.  Vars same as B<V>.
8432For more help, type B<h> I<cmd_letter>, or run B<$doccmd perldebug> for all docs.
8433END_SUM
8434
8435    # ')}}; # Fix balance of vi % matching
8436
8437} ## end sub sethelp
8438
8439=head2 C<print_help()>
8440
8441Most of what C<print_help> does is just text formatting. It finds the
8442C<B> and C<I> ornaments, cleans them off, and substitutes the proper
8443terminal control characters to simulate them (courtesy of
8444C<Term::ReadLine::TermCap>).
8445
8446=cut
8447
8448sub print_help {
8449    my $help_str = shift;
8450
8451    # Restore proper alignment destroyed by eeevil I<> and B<>
8452    # ornaments: A pox on both their houses!
8453    #
8454    # A help command will have everything up to and including
8455    # the first tab sequence padded into a field 16 (or if indented 20)
8456    # wide.  If it's wider than that, an extra space will be added.
8457    $help_str =~ s{
8458        ^                       # only matters at start of line
8459          ( \ {4} | \t )*       # some subcommands are indented
8460          ( < ?                 # so <CR> works
8461            [BI] < [^\t\n] + )  # find an eeevil ornament
8462          ( \t+ )               # original separation, discarded
8463          ( .* )                # this will now start (no earlier) than
8464                                # column 16
8465    } {
8466        my($leadwhite, $command, $midwhite, $text) = ($1, $2, $3, $4);
8467        my $clean = $command;
8468        $clean =~ s/[BI]<([^>]*)>/$1/g;
8469
8470        # replace with this whole string:
8471        ($leadwhite ? " " x 4 : "")
8472      . $command
8473      . ((" " x (16 + ($leadwhite ? 4 : 0) - length($clean))) || " ")
8474      . $text;
8475
8476    }mgex;
8477
8478    $help_str =~ s{                          # handle bold ornaments
8479       B < ( [^>] + | > ) >
8480    } {
8481          $Term::ReadLine::TermCap::rl_term_set[2]
8482        . $1
8483        . $Term::ReadLine::TermCap::rl_term_set[3]
8484    }gex;
8485
8486    $help_str =~ s{                         # handle italic ornaments
8487       I < ( [^>] + | > ) >
8488    } {
8489          $Term::ReadLine::TermCap::rl_term_set[0]
8490        . $1
8491        . $Term::ReadLine::TermCap::rl_term_set[1]
8492    }gex;
8493
8494    local $\ = '';
8495    print {$OUT} $help_str;
8496
8497    return;
8498} ## end sub print_help
8499
8500=head2 C<fix_less>
8501
8502This routine does a lot of gyrations to be sure that the pager is C<less>.
8503It checks for C<less> masquerading as C<more> and records the result in
8504C<$fixed_less> so we don't have to go through doing the stats again.
8505
8506=cut
8507
8508use vars qw($fixed_less);
8509
8510sub _calc_is_less {
8511    if ($pager =~ /\bless\b/)
8512    {
8513        return 1;
8514    }
8515    elsif ($pager =~ /\bmore\b/)
8516    {
8517        # Nope, set to more. See what's out there.
8518        my @st_more = stat('/usr/bin/more');
8519        my @st_less = stat('/usr/bin/less');
8520
8521        # is it really less, pretending to be more?
8522        return (
8523            @st_more
8524            && @st_less
8525            && $st_more[0] == $st_less[0]
8526            && $st_more[1] == $st_less[1]
8527        );
8528    }
8529    else {
8530        return;
8531    }
8532}
8533
8534sub fix_less {
8535
8536    # We already know if this is set.
8537    return if $fixed_less;
8538
8539    # changes environment!
8540    # 'r' added so we don't do (slow) stats again.
8541    $fixed_less = 1 if _calc_is_less();
8542
8543    return;
8544} ## end sub fix_less
8545
8546=head1 DIE AND WARN MANAGEMENT
8547
8548=head2 C<diesignal>
8549
8550C<diesignal> is a just-drop-dead C<die> handler. It's most useful when trying
8551to debug a debugger problem.
8552
8553It does its best to report the error that occurred, and then forces the
8554program, debugger, and everything to die.
8555
8556=cut
8557
8558sub diesignal {
8559
8560    # No entry/exit messages.
8561    local $frame = 0;
8562
8563    # No return value prints.
8564    local $doret = -2;
8565
8566    # set the abort signal handling to the default (just terminate).
8567    $SIG{'ABRT'} = 'DEFAULT';
8568
8569    # If we enter the signal handler recursively, kill myself with an
8570    # abort signal (so we just terminate).
8571    kill 'ABRT', $$ if $panic++;
8572
8573    # If we can show detailed info, do so.
8574    if ( defined &Carp::longmess ) {
8575
8576        # Don't recursively enter the warn handler, since we're carping.
8577        local $SIG{__WARN__} = '';
8578
8579        # Skip two levels before reporting traceback: we're skipping
8580        # mydie and confess.
8581        local $Carp::CarpLevel = 2;    # mydie + confess
8582
8583        # Tell us all about it.
8584        _db_warn( Carp::longmess("Signal @_") );
8585    }
8586
8587    # No Carp. Tell us about the signal as best we can.
8588    else {
8589        local $\ = '';
8590        print $DB::OUT "Got signal @_\n";
8591    }
8592
8593    # Drop dead.
8594    kill 'ABRT', $$;
8595} ## end sub diesignal
8596
8597=head2 C<dbwarn>
8598
8599The debugger's own default C<$SIG{__WARN__}> handler. We load C<Carp> to
8600be able to get a stack trace, and output the warning message vi C<DB::dbwarn()>.
8601
8602=cut
8603
8604sub dbwarn {
8605
8606    # No entry/exit trace.
8607    local $frame = 0;
8608
8609    # No return value printing.
8610    local $doret = -2;
8611
8612    # Turn off warn and die handling to prevent recursive entries to this
8613    # routine.
8614    local $SIG{__WARN__} = '';
8615    local $SIG{__DIE__}  = '';
8616
8617    # Load Carp if we can. If $^S is false (current thing being compiled isn't
8618    # done yet), we may not be able to do a require.
8619    eval { require Carp }
8620      if defined $^S;    # If error/warning during compilation,
8621                         # require may be broken.
8622
8623    # Use the core warn() unless Carp loaded OK.
8624    CORE::warn( @_,
8625        "\nCannot print stack trace, load with -MCarp option to see stack" ),
8626      return
8627      unless defined &Carp::longmess;
8628
8629    # Save the current values of $single and $trace, and then turn them off.
8630    my ( $mysingle, $mytrace ) = ( $single, $trace );
8631    $single = 0;
8632    $trace  = 0;
8633
8634    # We can call Carp::longmess without its being "debugged" (which we
8635    # don't want - we just want to use it!). Capture this for later.
8636    my $mess = Carp::longmess(@_);
8637
8638    # Restore $single and $trace to their original values.
8639    ( $single, $trace ) = ( $mysingle, $mytrace );
8640
8641    # Use the debugger's own special way of printing warnings to print
8642    # the stack trace message.
8643    _db_warn($mess);
8644} ## end sub dbwarn
8645
8646=head2 C<dbdie>
8647
8648The debugger's own C<$SIG{__DIE__}> handler. Handles providing a stack trace
8649by loading C<Carp> and calling C<Carp::longmess()> to get it. We turn off
8650single stepping and tracing during the call to C<Carp::longmess> to avoid
8651debugging it - we just want to use it.
8652
8653If C<dieLevel> is zero, we let the program being debugged handle the
8654exceptions. If it's 1, you get backtraces for any exception. If it's 2,
8655the debugger takes over all exception handling, printing a backtrace and
8656displaying the exception via its C<dbwarn()> routine.
8657
8658=cut
8659
8660sub dbdie {
8661    local $frame         = 0;
8662    local $doret         = -2;
8663    local $SIG{__DIE__}  = '';
8664    local $SIG{__WARN__} = '';
8665    if ( $dieLevel > 2 ) {
8666        local $SIG{__WARN__} = \&dbwarn;
8667        _db_warn(@_);    # Yell no matter what
8668        return;
8669    }
8670    if ( $dieLevel < 2 ) {
8671        die @_ if $^S;    # in eval propagate
8672    }
8673
8674    # The code used to check $^S to see if compilation of the current thing
8675    # hadn't finished. We don't do it anymore, figuring eval is pretty stable.
8676    eval { require Carp };
8677
8678    die( @_,
8679        "\nCannot print stack trace, load with -MCarp option to see stack" )
8680      unless defined &Carp::longmess;
8681
8682    # We do not want to debug this chunk (automatic disabling works
8683    # inside DB::DB, but not in Carp). Save $single and $trace, turn them off,
8684    # get the stack trace from Carp::longmess (if possible), restore $signal
8685    # and $trace, and then die with the stack trace.
8686    my ( $mysingle, $mytrace ) = ( $single, $trace );
8687    $single = 0;
8688    $trace  = 0;
8689    my $mess = "@_";
8690    {
8691
8692        package Carp;    # Do not include us in the list
8693        eval { $mess = Carp::longmess(@_); };
8694    }
8695    ( $single, $trace ) = ( $mysingle, $mytrace );
8696    die $mess;
8697} ## end sub dbdie
8698
8699=head2 C<warnlevel()>
8700
8701Set the C<$DB::warnLevel> variable that stores the value of the
8702C<warnLevel> option. Calling C<warnLevel()> with a positive value
8703results in the debugger taking over all warning handlers. Setting
8704C<warnLevel> to zero leaves any warning handlers set up by the program
8705being debugged in place.
8706
8707=cut
8708
8709sub warnLevel {
8710    if (@_) {
8711        my $prevwarn = $SIG{__WARN__} unless $warnLevel;
8712        $warnLevel = shift;
8713        if ($warnLevel) {
8714            $SIG{__WARN__} = \&DB::dbwarn;
8715        }
8716        elsif ($prevwarn) {
8717            $SIG{__WARN__} = $prevwarn;
8718        } else {
8719            undef $SIG{__WARN__};
8720        }
8721    } ## end if (@_)
8722    $warnLevel;
8723} ## end sub warnLevel
8724
8725=head2 C<dielevel>
8726
8727Similar to C<warnLevel>. Non-zero values for C<dieLevel> result in the
8728C<DB::dbdie()> function overriding any other C<die()> handler. Setting it to
8729zero lets you use your own C<die()> handler.
8730
8731=cut
8732
8733sub dieLevel {
8734    local $\ = '';
8735    if (@_) {
8736        my $prevdie = $SIG{__DIE__} unless $dieLevel;
8737        $dieLevel = shift;
8738        if ($dieLevel) {
8739
8740            # Always set it to dbdie() for non-zero values.
8741            $SIG{__DIE__} = \&DB::dbdie;    # if $dieLevel < 2;
8742
8743            # No longer exists, so don't try  to use it.
8744            #$SIG{__DIE__} = \&DB::diehard if $dieLevel >= 2;
8745
8746            # If we've finished initialization, mention that stack dumps
8747            # are enabled, If dieLevel is 1, we won't stack dump if we die
8748            # in an eval().
8749            print $OUT "Stack dump during die enabled",
8750              ( $dieLevel == 1 ? " outside of evals" : "" ), ".\n"
8751              if $I_m_init;
8752
8753            # XXX This is probably obsolete, given that diehard() is gone.
8754            print $OUT "Dump printed too.\n" if $dieLevel > 2;
8755        } ## end if ($dieLevel)
8756
8757        # Put the old one back if there was one.
8758        elsif ($prevdie) {
8759            $SIG{__DIE__} = $prevdie;
8760            print $OUT "Default die handler restored.\n";
8761        } else {
8762            undef $SIG{__DIE__};
8763            print $OUT "Die handler removed.\n";
8764        }
8765    } ## end if (@_)
8766    $dieLevel;
8767} ## end sub dieLevel
8768
8769=head2 C<signalLevel>
8770
8771Number three in a series: set C<signalLevel> to zero to keep your own
8772signal handler for C<SIGSEGV> and/or C<SIGBUS>. Otherwise, the debugger
8773takes over and handles them with C<DB::diesignal()>.
8774
8775=cut
8776
8777sub signalLevel {
8778    if (@_) {
8779        my $prevsegv = $SIG{SEGV} unless $signalLevel;
8780        my $prevbus  = $SIG{BUS}  unless $signalLevel;
8781        $signalLevel = shift;
8782        if ($signalLevel) {
8783            $SIG{SEGV} = \&DB::diesignal;
8784            $SIG{BUS}  = \&DB::diesignal;
8785        }
8786        else {
8787            $SIG{SEGV} = $prevsegv;
8788            $SIG{BUS}  = $prevbus;
8789        }
8790    } ## end if (@_)
8791    $signalLevel;
8792} ## end sub signalLevel
8793
8794=head1 SUBROUTINE DECODING SUPPORT
8795
8796These subroutines are used during the C<x> and C<X> commands to try to
8797produce as much information as possible about a code reference. They use
8798L<Devel::Peek> to try to find the glob in which this code reference lives
8799(if it does) - this allows us to actually code references which correspond
8800to named subroutines (including those aliased via glob assignment).
8801
8802=head2 C<CvGV_name()>
8803
8804Wrapper for C<CvGV_name_or_bust>; tries to get the name of a reference
8805via that routine. If this fails, return the reference again (when the
8806reference is stringified, it'll come out as C<SOMETHING(0x...)>).
8807
8808=cut
8809
8810sub CvGV_name {
8811    my $in   = shift;
8812    my $name = CvGV_name_or_bust($in);
8813    defined $name ? $name : $in;
8814}
8815
8816=head2 C<CvGV_name_or_bust> I<coderef>
8817
8818Calls L<Devel::Peek> to try to find the glob the ref lives in; returns
8819C<undef> if L<Devel::Peek> can't be loaded, or if C<Devel::Peek::CvGV> can't
8820find a glob for this ref.
8821
8822Returns C<< I<package>::I<glob name> >> if the code ref is found in a glob.
8823
8824=cut
8825
8826use vars qw($skipCvGV);
8827
8828sub CvGV_name_or_bust {
8829    my $in = shift;
8830    return if $skipCvGV;    # Backdoor to avoid problems if XS broken...
8831    return unless ref $in;
8832    $in = \&$in;            # Hard reference...
8833    eval { require Devel::Peek; 1 } or return;
8834    my $gv = Devel::Peek::CvGV($in) or return;
8835    *$gv{PACKAGE} . '::' . *$gv{NAME};
8836} ## end sub CvGV_name_or_bust
8837
8838=head2 C<find_sub>
8839
8840A utility routine used in various places; finds the file where a subroutine
8841was defined, and returns that filename and a line-number range.
8842
8843Tries to use C<@sub> first; if it can't find it there, it tries building a
8844reference to the subroutine and uses C<CvGV_name_or_bust> to locate it,
8845loading it into C<@sub> as a side effect (XXX I think). If it can't find it
8846this way, it brute-force searches C<%sub>, checking for identical references.
8847
8848=cut
8849
8850sub _find_sub_helper {
8851    my $subr = shift;
8852
8853    return unless defined &$subr;
8854    my $name = CvGV_name_or_bust($subr);
8855    my $data;
8856    $data = $sub{$name} if defined $name;
8857    return $data if defined $data;
8858
8859    # Old stupid way...
8860    $subr = \&$subr;    # Hard reference
8861    my $s;
8862    for ( keys %sub ) {
8863        $s = $_, last if $subr eq \&$_;
8864    }
8865    if ($s)
8866    {
8867        return $sub{$s};
8868    }
8869    else
8870    {
8871        return;
8872    }
8873
8874}
8875
8876sub find_sub {
8877    my $subr = shift;
8878    return ( $sub{$subr} || _find_sub_helper($subr) );
8879} ## end sub find_sub
8880
8881=head2 C<methods>
8882
8883A subroutine that uses the utility function C<methods_via> to find all the
8884methods in the class corresponding to the current reference and in
8885C<UNIVERSAL>.
8886
8887=cut
8888
8889use vars qw(%seen);
8890
8891sub methods {
8892
8893    # Figure out the class - either this is the class or it's a reference
8894    # to something blessed into that class.
8895    my $class = shift;
8896    $class = ref $class if ref $class;
8897
8898    local %seen;
8899
8900    # Show the methods that this class has.
8901    methods_via( $class, '', 1 );
8902
8903    # Show the methods that UNIVERSAL has.
8904    methods_via( 'UNIVERSAL', 'UNIVERSAL', 0 );
8905} ## end sub methods
8906
8907=head2 C<methods_via($class, $prefix, $crawl_upward)>
8908
8909C<methods_via> does the work of crawling up the C<@ISA> tree and reporting
8910all the parent class methods. C<$class> is the name of the next class to
8911try; C<$prefix> is the message prefix, which gets built up as we go up the
8912C<@ISA> tree to show parentage; C<$crawl_upward> is 1 if we should try to go
8913higher in the C<@ISA> tree, 0 if we should stop.
8914
8915=cut
8916
8917sub methods_via {
8918
8919    # If we've processed this class already, just quit.
8920    my $class = shift;
8921    return if $seen{$class}++;
8922
8923    # This is a package that is contributing the methods we're about to print.
8924    my $prefix  = shift;
8925    my $prepend = $prefix ? "via $prefix: " : '';
8926    my @to_print;
8927
8928    # Extract from all the symbols in this class.
8929    my $class_ref = do { no strict "refs"; \%{$class . '::'} };
8930    while (my ($name, $glob) = each %$class_ref) {
8931        # references directly in the symbol table are Proxy Constant
8932        # Subroutines, and are by their very nature defined
8933        # Otherwise, check if the thing is a typeglob, and if it is, it decays
8934        # to a subroutine reference, which can be tested by defined.
8935        # $glob might also be the value -1  (from sub foo;)
8936        # or (say) '$$' (from sub foo ($$);)
8937        # \$glob will be SCALAR in both cases.
8938        if ((ref $glob || ($glob && ref \$glob eq 'GLOB' && defined &$glob))
8939            && !$seen{$name}++) {
8940            push @to_print, "$prepend$name\n";
8941        }
8942    }
8943
8944    {
8945        local $\ = '';
8946        local $, = '';
8947        print $DB::OUT $_ foreach sort @to_print;
8948    }
8949
8950    # If the $crawl_upward argument is false, just quit here.
8951    return unless shift;
8952
8953    # $crawl_upward true: keep going up the tree.
8954    # Find all the classes this one is a subclass of.
8955    my $class_ISA_ref = do { no strict "refs"; \@{"${class}::ISA"} };
8956    for my $name ( @$class_ISA_ref ) {
8957
8958        # Set up the new prefix.
8959        $prepend = $prefix ? $prefix . " -> $name" : $name;
8960
8961        # Crawl up the tree and keep trying to crawl up.
8962        methods_via( $name, $prepend, 1 );
8963    }
8964} ## end sub methods_via
8965
8966=head2 C<setman> - figure out which command to use to show documentation
8967
8968Just checks the contents of C<$^O> and sets the C<$doccmd> global accordingly.
8969
8970=cut
8971
8972sub setman {
8973    $doccmd = $^O !~ /^(?:MSWin32|VMS|os2|dos|amigaos|riscos|NetWare)\z/s
8974      ? "man"         # O Happy Day!
8975      : "perldoc";    # Alas, poor unfortunates
8976} ## end sub setman
8977
8978=head2 C<runman> - run the appropriate command to show documentation
8979
8980Accepts a man page name; runs the appropriate command to display it (set up
8981during debugger initialization). Uses C<_db_system()> to avoid mucking up the
8982program's STDIN and STDOUT.
8983
8984=cut
8985
8986sub runman {
8987    my $page = shift;
8988    unless ($page) {
8989        _db_system("$doccmd $doccmd");
8990        return;
8991    }
8992
8993    # this way user can override, like with $doccmd="man -Mwhatever"
8994    # or even just "man " to disable the path check.
8995    if ( $doccmd ne 'man' ) {
8996        _db_system("$doccmd $page");
8997        return;
8998    }
8999
9000    $page = 'perl' if lc($page) eq 'help';
9001
9002    require Config;
9003    my $man1dir = $Config::Config{man1direxp};
9004    my $man3dir = $Config::Config{man3direxp};
9005    for ( $man1dir, $man3dir ) { s#/[^/]*\z## if /\S/ }
9006    my $manpath = '';
9007    $manpath .= "$man1dir:" if $man1dir =~ /\S/;
9008    $manpath .= "$man3dir:" if $man3dir =~ /\S/ && $man1dir ne $man3dir;
9009    chop $manpath if $manpath;
9010
9011    # harmless if missing, I figure
9012    local $ENV{MANPATH} = $manpath if $manpath;
9013    my $nopathopt = $^O =~ /dunno what goes here/;
9014    if (
9015        CORE::system(
9016            $doccmd,
9017
9018            # I just *know* there are men without -M
9019            ( ( $manpath && !$nopathopt ) ? ( "-M", $manpath ) : () ),
9020            split ' ', $page
9021        )
9022      )
9023    {
9024        unless ( $page =~ /^perl\w/ ) {
9025            # Previously the debugger contained a list which it slurped in,
9026            # listing the known "perl" manpages. However, it was out of date,
9027            # with errors both of omission and inclusion. This approach is
9028            # considerably less complex. The failure mode on a butchered
9029            # install is simply that the user has to run man or perldoc
9030            # "manually" with the full manpage name.
9031
9032            # There is a list of $^O values in installperl to determine whether
9033            # the directory is 'pods' or 'pod'. However, we can avoid tight
9034            # coupling to that by simply checking the "non-standard" 'pods'
9035            # first.
9036            my $pods = "$Config::Config{privlibexp}/pods";
9037            $pods = "$Config::Config{privlibexp}/pod"
9038                unless -d $pods;
9039            if (-f "$pods/perl$page.pod") {
9040                CORE::system( $doccmd,
9041                    ( ( $manpath && !$nopathopt ) ? ( "-M", $manpath ) : () ),
9042                    "perl$page" );
9043            }
9044        }
9045    } ## end if (CORE::system($doccmd...
9046} ## end sub runman
9047
9048#use Carp;                          # This did break, left for debugging
9049
9050=head1 DEBUGGER INITIALIZATION - THE SECOND BEGIN BLOCK
9051
9052Because of the way the debugger interface to the Perl core is designed, any
9053debugger package globals that C<DB::sub()> requires have to be defined before
9054any subroutines can be called. These are defined in the second C<BEGIN> block.
9055
9056This block sets things up so that (basically) the world is sane
9057before the debugger starts executing. We set up various variables that the
9058debugger has to have set up before the Perl core starts running:
9059
9060=over 4
9061
9062=item *
9063
9064The debugger's own filehandles (copies of STD and STDOUT for now).
9065
9066=item *
9067
9068Characters for shell escapes, the recall command, and the history command.
9069
9070=item *
9071
9072The maximum recursion depth.
9073
9074=item *
9075
9076The size of a C<w> command's window.
9077
9078=item *
9079
9080The before-this-line context to be printed in a C<v> (view a window around this line) command.
9081
9082=item *
9083
9084The fact that we're not in a sub at all right now.
9085
9086=item *
9087
9088The default SIGINT handler for the debugger.
9089
9090=item *
9091
9092The appropriate value of the flag in C<$^D> that says the debugger is running
9093
9094=item *
9095
9096The current debugger recursion level
9097
9098=item *
9099
9100The list of postponed items and the C<$single> stack (XXX define this)
9101
9102=item *
9103
9104That we want no return values and no subroutine entry/exit trace.
9105
9106=back
9107
9108=cut
9109
9110# The following BEGIN is very handy if debugger goes havoc, debugging debugger?
9111
9112use vars qw($db_stop);
9113
9114BEGIN {    # This does not compile, alas. (XXX eh?)
9115    $IN  = \*STDIN;     # For bugs before DB::OUT has been opened
9116    $OUT = \*STDERR;    # For errors before DB::OUT has been opened
9117
9118    # Define characters used by command parsing.
9119    $sh       = '!';      # Shell escape (does not work)
9120    $rc       = ',';      # Recall command (does not work)
9121    @hist     = ('?');    # Show history (does not work)
9122    @truehist = ();       # Can be saved for replay (per session)
9123
9124    # This defines the point at which you get the 'deep recursion'
9125    # warning. It MUST be defined or the debugger will not load.
9126    $deep = 1000;
9127
9128    # Number of lines around the current one that are shown in the
9129    # 'w' command.
9130    $window = 10;
9131
9132    # How much before-the-current-line context the 'v' command should
9133    # use in calculating the start of the window it will display.
9134    $preview = 3;
9135
9136    # We're not in any sub yet, but we need this to be a defined value.
9137    $sub = '';
9138
9139    # Set up the debugger's interrupt handler. It simply sets a flag
9140    # ($signal) that DB::DB() will check before each command is executed.
9141    $SIG{INT} = \&DB::catch;
9142
9143    # The following lines supposedly, if uncommented, allow the debugger to
9144    # debug itself. Perhaps we can try that someday.
9145    # This may be enabled to debug debugger:
9146    #$warnLevel = 1 unless defined $warnLevel;
9147    #$dieLevel = 1 unless defined $dieLevel;
9148    #$signalLevel = 1 unless defined $signalLevel;
9149
9150    # This is the flag that says "a debugger is running, please call
9151    # DB::DB and DB::sub". We will turn it on forcibly before we try to
9152    # execute anything in the user's context, because we always want to
9153    # get control back.
9154    $db_stop = 0;          # Compiler warning ...
9155    $db_stop = 1 << 30;    # ... because this is only used in an eval() later.
9156
9157    # This variable records how many levels we're nested in debugging. Used
9158    # Used in the debugger prompt, and in determining whether it's all over or
9159    # not.
9160    $level = 0;            # Level of recursive debugging
9161
9162    # "Triggers bug (?) in perl if we postpone this until runtime."
9163    # XXX No details on this yet, or whether we should fix the bug instead
9164    # of work around it. Stay tuned.
9165    @stack = (0);
9166
9167    # Used to track the current stack depth using the auto-stacked-variable
9168    # trick.
9169    $stack_depth = 0;      # Localized repeatedly; simple way to track $#stack
9170
9171    # Don't print return values on exiting a subroutine.
9172    $doret = -2;
9173
9174    # No extry/exit tracing.
9175    $frame = 0;
9176
9177} ## end BEGIN
9178
9179BEGIN { $^W = $ini_warn; }    # Switch warnings back
9180
9181=head1 READLINE SUPPORT - COMPLETION FUNCTION
9182
9183=head2 db_complete
9184
9185C<readline> support - adds command completion to basic C<readline>.
9186
9187Returns a list of possible completions to C<readline> when invoked. C<readline>
9188will print the longest common substring following the text already entered.
9189
9190If there is only a single possible completion, C<readline> will use it in full.
9191
9192This code uses C<map> and C<grep> heavily to create lists of possible
9193completion. Think LISP in this section.
9194
9195=cut
9196
9197sub db_complete {
9198
9199    # Specific code for b c l V m f O, &blah, $blah, @blah, %blah
9200    # $text is the text to be completed.
9201    # $line is the incoming line typed by the user.
9202    # $start is the start of the text to be completed in the incoming line.
9203    my ( $text, $line, $start ) = @_;
9204
9205    # Save the initial text.
9206    # The search pattern is current package, ::, extract the next qualifier
9207    # Prefix and pack are set to undef.
9208    my ( $itext, $search, $prefix, $pack ) =
9209      ( $text, "^\Q${package}::\E([^:]+)\$" );
9210
9211=head3 C<b postpone|compile>
9212
9213=over 4
9214
9215=item *
9216
9217Find all the subroutines that might match in this package
9218
9219=item *
9220
9221Add C<postpone>, C<load>, and C<compile> as possibles (we may be completing the keyword itself)
9222
9223=item *
9224
9225Include all the rest of the subs that are known
9226
9227=item *
9228
9229C<grep> out the ones that match the text we have so far
9230
9231=item *
9232
9233Return this as the list of possible completions
9234
9235=back
9236
9237=cut
9238
9239    return sort grep /^\Q$text/, ( keys %sub ),
9240      qw(postpone load compile),    # subroutines
9241      ( map { /$search/ ? ($1) : () } keys %sub )
9242      if ( substr $line, 0, $start ) =~ /^\|*[blc]\s+((postpone|compile)\s+)?$/;
9243
9244=head3 C<b load>
9245
9246Get all the possible files from C<@INC> as it currently stands and
9247select the ones that match the text so far.
9248
9249=cut
9250
9251    return sort grep /^\Q$text/, values %INC    # files
9252      if ( substr $line, 0, $start ) =~ /^\|*b\s+load\s+$/;
9253
9254=head3  C<V> (list variable) and C<m> (list modules)
9255
9256There are two entry points for these commands:
9257
9258=head4 Unqualified package names
9259
9260Get the top-level packages and grab everything that matches the text
9261so far. For each match, recursively complete the partial packages to
9262get all possible matching packages. Return this sorted list.
9263
9264=cut
9265
9266    return sort map { ( $_, db_complete( $_ . "::", "V ", 2 ) ) }
9267      grep /^\Q$text/, map { /^(.*)::$/ ? ($1) : () } keys %::    # top-packages
9268      if ( substr $line, 0, $start ) =~ /^\|*[Vm]\s+$/ and $text =~ /^\w*$/;
9269
9270=head4 Qualified package names
9271
9272Take a partially-qualified package and find all subpackages for it
9273by getting all the subpackages for the package so far, matching all
9274the subpackages against the text, and discarding all of them which
9275start with 'main::'. Return this list.
9276
9277=cut
9278
9279    return sort map { ( $_, db_complete( $_ . "::", "V ", 2 ) ) }
9280      grep !/^main::/, grep /^\Q$text/,
9281      map { /^(.*)::$/ ? ( $prefix . "::$1" ) : () }
9282      do { no strict 'refs'; keys %{ $prefix . '::' } }
9283      if ( substr $line, 0, $start ) =~ /^\|*[Vm]\s+$/
9284      and $text =~ /^(.*[^:])::?(\w*)$/
9285      and $prefix = $1;
9286
9287=head3 C<f> - switch files
9288
9289Here, we want to get a fully-qualified filename for the C<f> command.
9290Possibilities are:
9291
9292=over 4
9293
9294=item 1. The original source file itself
9295
9296=item 2. A file from C<@INC>
9297
9298=item 3. An C<eval> (the debugger gets a C<(eval N)> fake file for each C<eval>).
9299
9300=back
9301
9302=cut
9303
9304    if ( $line =~ /^\|*f\s+(.*)/ ) {    # Loaded files
9305           # We might possibly want to switch to an eval (which has a "filename"
9306           # like '(eval 9)'), so we may need to clean up the completion text
9307           # before proceeding.
9308        $prefix = length($1) - length($text);
9309        $text   = $1;
9310
9311=pod
9312
9313Under the debugger, source files are represented as C<_E<lt>/fullpath/to/file>
9314(C<eval>s are C<_E<lt>(eval NNN)>) keys in C<%main::>. We pull all of these
9315out of C<%main::>, add the initial source file, and extract the ones that
9316match the completion text so far.
9317
9318=cut
9319
9320        return sort
9321          map { substr $_, 2 + $prefix } grep /^_<\Q$text/, ( keys %main:: ),
9322          $0;
9323    } ## end if ($line =~ /^\|*f\s+(.*)/)
9324
9325=head3 Subroutine name completion
9326
9327We look through all of the defined subs (the keys of C<%sub>) and
9328return both all the possible matches to the subroutine name plus
9329all the matches qualified to the current package.
9330
9331=cut
9332
9333    if ( ( substr $text, 0, 1 ) eq '&' ) {    # subroutines
9334        $text = substr $text, 1;
9335        $prefix = "&";
9336        return sort map "$prefix$_", grep /^\Q$text/, ( keys %sub ),
9337          (
9338            map { /$search/ ? ($1) : () }
9339              keys %sub
9340          );
9341    } ## end if ((substr $text, 0, ...
9342
9343=head3  Scalar, array, and hash completion: partially qualified package
9344
9345Much like the above, except we have to do a little more cleanup:
9346
9347=cut
9348
9349    if ( $text =~ /^[\$@%](.*)::(.*)/ ) {    # symbols in a package
9350
9351=pod
9352
9353=over 4
9354
9355=item *
9356
9357Determine the package that the symbol is in. Put it in C<::> (effectively C<main::>) if no package is specified.
9358
9359=cut
9360
9361        $pack = ( $1 eq 'main' ? '' : $1 ) . '::';
9362
9363=pod
9364
9365=item *
9366
9367Figure out the prefix vs. what needs completing.
9368
9369=cut
9370
9371        $prefix = ( substr $text, 0, 1 ) . $1 . '::';
9372        $text   = $2;
9373
9374=pod
9375
9376=item *
9377
9378Look through all the symbols in the package. C<grep> out all the possible hashes/arrays/scalars, and then C<grep> the possible matches out of those. C<map> the prefix onto all the possibilities.
9379
9380=cut
9381
9382        my @out = do {
9383            no strict 'refs';
9384            map "$prefix$_", grep /^\Q$text/, grep /^_?[a-zA-Z]/,
9385            keys %$pack;
9386        };
9387
9388=pod
9389
9390=item *
9391
9392If there's only one hit, and it's a package qualifier, and it's not equal to the initial text, re-complete it using the symbol we actually found.
9393
9394=cut
9395
9396        if ( @out == 1 and $out[0] =~ /::$/ and $out[0] ne $itext ) {
9397            return db_complete( $out[0], $line, $start );
9398        }
9399
9400        # Return the list of possibles.
9401        return sort @out;
9402
9403    } ## end if ($text =~ /^[\$@%](.*)::(.*)/)
9404
9405=pod
9406
9407=back
9408
9409=head3 Symbol completion: current package or package C<main>.
9410
9411=cut
9412
9413    if ( $text =~ /^[\$@%]/ ) {    # symbols (in $package + packages in main)
9414=pod
9415
9416=over 4
9417
9418=item *
9419
9420If it's C<main>, delete main to just get C<::> leading.
9421
9422=cut
9423
9424        $pack = ( $package eq 'main' ? '' : $package ) . '::';
9425
9426=pod
9427
9428=item *
9429
9430We set the prefix to the item's sigil, and trim off the sigil to get the text to be completed.
9431
9432=cut
9433
9434        $prefix = substr $text, 0, 1;
9435        $text   = substr $text, 1;
9436
9437        my @out;
9438
9439=pod
9440
9441=item *
9442
9443We look for the lexical scope above DB::DB and auto-complete lexical variables
9444if PadWalker could be loaded.
9445
9446=cut
9447
9448        if (not $text =~ /::/ and eval {
9449            local @INC = @INC;
9450            pop @INC if $INC[-1] eq '.';
9451            require PadWalker } ) {
9452            my $level = 1;
9453            while (1) {
9454                my @info = caller($level);
9455                $level++;
9456                $level = -1, last
9457                  if not @info;
9458                last if $info[3] eq 'DB::DB';
9459            }
9460            if ($level > 0) {
9461                my $lexicals = PadWalker::peek_my($level);
9462                push @out, grep /^\Q$prefix$text/, keys %$lexicals;
9463            }
9464        }
9465
9466=pod
9467
9468=item *
9469
9470If the package is C<::> (C<main>), create an empty list; if it's something else, create a list of all the packages known.  Append whichever list to a list of all the possible symbols in the current package. C<grep> out the matches to the text entered so far, then C<map> the prefix back onto the symbols.
9471
9472=cut
9473
9474        push @out, map "$prefix$_", grep /^\Q$text/,
9475          ( grep /^_?[a-zA-Z]/, do { no strict 'refs'; keys %$pack } ),
9476          ( $pack eq '::' ? () : ( grep /::$/, keys %:: ) );
9477
9478=item *
9479
9480If there's only one hit, it's a package qualifier, and it's not equal to the initial text, recomplete using this symbol.
9481
9482=back
9483
9484=cut
9485
9486        if ( @out == 1 and $out[0] =~ /::$/ and $out[0] ne $itext ) {
9487            return db_complete( $out[0], $line, $start );
9488        }
9489
9490        # Return the list of possibles.
9491        return sort @out;
9492    } ## end if ($text =~ /^[\$@%]/)
9493
9494=head3 Options
9495
9496We use C<option_val()> to look up the current value of the option. If there's
9497only a single value, we complete the command in such a way that it is a
9498complete command for setting the option in question. If there are multiple
9499possible values, we generate a command consisting of the option plus a trailing
9500question mark, which, if executed, will list the current value of the option.
9501
9502=cut
9503
9504    if ( ( substr $line, 0, $start ) =~ /^\|*[oO]\b.*\s$/ )
9505    {    # Options after space
9506           # We look for the text to be matched in the list of possible options,
9507           # and fetch the current value.
9508        my @out = grep /^\Q$text/, @options;
9509        my $val = option_val( $out[0], undef );
9510
9511        # Set up a 'query option's value' command.
9512        my $out = '? ';
9513        if ( not defined $val or $val =~ /[\n\r]/ ) {
9514
9515            # There's really nothing else we can do.
9516        }
9517
9518        # We have a value. Create a proper option-setting command.
9519        elsif ( $val =~ /\s/ ) {
9520
9521            # XXX This may be an extraneous variable.
9522            my $found;
9523
9524            # We'll want to quote the string (because of the embedded
9525            # whtespace), but we want to make sure we don't end up with
9526            # mismatched quote characters. We try several possibilities.
9527            foreach my $l ( split //, qq/\"\'\#\|/ ) {
9528
9529                # If we didn't find this quote character in the value,
9530                # quote it using this quote character.
9531                $out = "$l$val$l ", last if ( index $val, $l ) == -1;
9532            }
9533        } ## end elsif ($val =~ /\s/)
9534
9535        # Don't need any quotes.
9536        else {
9537            $out = "=$val ";
9538        }
9539
9540        # If there were multiple possible values, return '? ', which
9541        # makes the command into a query command. If there was just one,
9542        # have readline append that.
9543        $rl_attribs->{completer_terminator_character} =
9544          ( @out == 1 ? $out : '? ' );
9545
9546        # Return list of possibilities.
9547        return sort @out;
9548    } ## end if ((substr $line, 0, ...
9549
9550=head3 Filename completion
9551
9552For entering filenames. We simply call C<readline>'s C<filename_list()>
9553method with the completion text to get the possible completions.
9554
9555=cut
9556
9557    return $term->filename_list($text);    # filenames
9558
9559} ## end sub db_complete
9560
9561=head1 MISCELLANEOUS SUPPORT FUNCTIONS
9562
9563Functions that possibly ought to be somewhere else.
9564
9565=head2 end_report
9566
9567Say we're done.
9568
9569=cut
9570
9571sub end_report {
9572    local $\ = '';
9573    print $OUT "Use 'q' to quit or 'R' to restart.  'h q' for details.\n";
9574}
9575
9576=head2 clean_ENV
9577
9578If we have $ini_pids, save it in the environment; else remove it from the
9579environment. Used by the C<R> (restart) command.
9580
9581=cut
9582
9583sub clean_ENV {
9584    if ( defined($ini_pids) ) {
9585        $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS} = $ini_pids;
9586    }
9587    else {
9588        delete( $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS} );
9589    }
9590} ## end sub clean_ENV
9591
9592# PERLDBf_... flag names from perl.h
9593our ( %DollarCaretP_flags, %DollarCaretP_flags_r );
9594
9595BEGIN {
9596    %DollarCaretP_flags = (
9597        PERLDBf_SUB       => 0x01,     # Debug sub enter/exit
9598        PERLDBf_LINE      => 0x02,     # Keep line #
9599        PERLDBf_NOOPT     => 0x04,     # Switch off optimizations
9600        PERLDBf_INTER     => 0x08,     # Preserve more data
9601        PERLDBf_SUBLINE   => 0x10,     # Keep subr source lines
9602        PERLDBf_SINGLE    => 0x20,     # Start with single-step on
9603        PERLDBf_NONAME    => 0x40,     # For _SUB: no name of the subr
9604        PERLDBf_GOTO      => 0x80,     # Report goto: call DB::goto
9605        PERLDBf_NAMEEVAL  => 0x100,    # Informative names for evals
9606        PERLDBf_NAMEANON  => 0x200,    # Informative names for anon subs
9607        PERLDBf_SAVESRC   => 0x400,    # Save source lines into @{"_<$filename"}
9608        PERLDB_ALL        => 0x33f,    # No _NONAME, _GOTO
9609    );
9610    # PERLDBf_LINE also enables the actions of PERLDBf_SAVESRC, so the debugger
9611    # doesn't need to set it. It's provided for the benefit of profilers and
9612    # other code analysers.
9613
9614    %DollarCaretP_flags_r = reverse %DollarCaretP_flags;
9615}
9616
9617sub parse_DollarCaretP_flags {
9618    my $flags = shift;
9619    $flags =~ s/^\s+//;
9620    $flags =~ s/\s+$//;
9621    my $acu = 0;
9622    foreach my $f ( split /\s*\|\s*/, $flags ) {
9623        my $value;
9624        if ( $f =~ /^0x([[:xdigit:]]+)$/ ) {
9625            $value = hex $1;
9626        }
9627        elsif ( $f =~ /^(\d+)$/ ) {
9628            $value = int $1;
9629        }
9630        elsif ( $f =~ /^DEFAULT$/i ) {
9631            $value = $DollarCaretP_flags{PERLDB_ALL};
9632        }
9633        else {
9634            $f =~ /^(?:PERLDBf_)?(.*)$/i;
9635            $value = $DollarCaretP_flags{ 'PERLDBf_' . uc($1) };
9636            unless ( defined $value ) {
9637                print $OUT (
9638                    "Unrecognized \$^P flag '$f'!\n",
9639                    "Acceptable flags are: "
9640                      . join( ', ', sort keys %DollarCaretP_flags ),
9641                    ", and hexadecimal and decimal numbers.\n"
9642                );
9643                return undef;
9644            }
9645        }
9646        $acu |= $value;
9647    }
9648    $acu;
9649}
9650
9651sub expand_DollarCaretP_flags {
9652    my $DollarCaretP = shift;
9653    my @bits         = (
9654        map {
9655            my $n = ( 1 << $_ );
9656            ( $DollarCaretP & $n )
9657              ? ( $DollarCaretP_flags_r{$n}
9658                  || sprintf( '0x%x', $n ) )
9659              : ()
9660          } 0 .. 31
9661    );
9662    return @bits ? join( '|', @bits ) : 0;
9663}
9664
9665=over 4
9666
9667=item rerun
9668
9669Rerun the current session to:
9670
9671    rerun        current position
9672
9673    rerun 4      command number 4
9674
9675    rerun -4     current command minus 4 (go back 4 steps)
9676
9677Whether this always makes sense, in the current context is unknowable, and is
9678in part left as a useful exercise for the reader.  This sub returns the
9679appropriate arguments to rerun the current session.
9680
9681=cut
9682
9683sub rerun {
9684    my $i = shift;
9685    my @args;
9686    pop(@truehist);                      # strim
9687    unless (defined $truehist[$i]) {
9688        print "Unable to return to non-existent command: $i\n";
9689    } else {
9690        $#truehist = ($i < 0 ? $#truehist + $i : $i > 0 ? $i : $#truehist);
9691        my @temp = @truehist;            # store
9692        push(@DB::typeahead, @truehist); # saved
9693        @truehist = @hist = ();          # flush
9694        @args = restart();              # setup
9695        get_list("PERLDB_HIST");        # clean
9696        set_list("PERLDB_HIST", @temp); # reset
9697    }
9698    return @args;
9699}
9700
9701=item restart
9702
9703Restarting the debugger is a complex operation that occurs in several phases.
9704First, we try to reconstruct the command line that was used to invoke Perl
9705and the debugger.
9706
9707=cut
9708
9709sub restart {
9710    # I may not be able to resurrect you, but here goes ...
9711    print $OUT
9712"Warning: some settings and command-line options may be lost!\n";
9713    my ( @script, @flags, $cl );
9714
9715    # If warn was on before, turn it on again.
9716    push @flags, '-w' if $ini_warn;
9717
9718    # Rebuild the -I flags that were on the initial
9719    # command line.
9720    for (@ini_INC) {
9721        push @flags, '-I', $_;
9722    }
9723
9724    # Turn on taint if it was on before.
9725    push @flags, '-T' if ${^TAINT};
9726
9727    # Arrange for setting the old INC:
9728    # Save the current @init_INC in the environment.
9729    set_list( "PERLDB_INC", @ini_INC );
9730
9731    # If this was a perl one-liner, go to the "file"
9732    # corresponding to the one-liner read all the lines
9733    # out of it (except for the first one, which is going
9734    # to be added back on again when 'perl -d' runs: that's
9735    # the 'require perl5db.pl;' line), and add them back on
9736    # to the command line to be executed.
9737    if ( $0 eq '-e' ) {
9738        my $lines = *{$main::{'_<-e'}}{ARRAY};
9739        for ( 1 .. $#$lines ) {  # The first line is PERL5DB
9740            chomp( $cl = $lines->[$_] );
9741            push @script, '-e', $cl;
9742        }
9743    } ## end if ($0 eq '-e')
9744
9745    # Otherwise we just reuse the original name we had
9746    # before.
9747    else {
9748        @script = $0;
9749    }
9750
9751=pod
9752
9753After the command line  has been reconstructed, the next step is to save
9754the debugger's status in environment variables. The C<DB::set_list> routine
9755is used to save aggregate variables (both hashes and arrays); scalars are
9756just popped into environment variables directly.
9757
9758=cut
9759
9760    # If the terminal supported history, grab it and
9761    # save that in the environment.
9762    set_list( "PERLDB_HIST",
9763          $term->Features->{getHistory}
9764        ? $term->GetHistory
9765        : @hist );
9766
9767    # Find all the files that were visited during this
9768    # session (i.e., the debugger had magic hashes
9769    # corresponding to them) and stick them in the environment.
9770    my @had_breakpoints = keys %had_breakpoints;
9771    set_list( "PERLDB_VISITED", @had_breakpoints );
9772
9773    # Save the debugger options we chose.
9774    set_list( "PERLDB_OPT", %option );
9775    # set_list( "PERLDB_OPT", options2remember() );
9776
9777    # Save the break-on-loads.
9778    set_list( "PERLDB_ON_LOAD", %break_on_load );
9779
9780=pod
9781
9782The most complex part of this is the saving of all of the breakpoints. They
9783can live in an awful lot of places, and we have to go through all of them,
9784find the breakpoints, and then save them in the appropriate environment
9785variable via C<DB::set_list>.
9786
9787=cut
9788
9789    # Go through all the breakpoints and make sure they're
9790    # still valid.
9791    my @hard;
9792    for ( 0 .. $#had_breakpoints ) {
9793
9794        # We were in this file.
9795        my $file = $had_breakpoints[$_];
9796
9797        # Grab that file's magic line hash.
9798        *dbline = $main::{ '_<' . $file };
9799
9800        # Skip out if it doesn't exist, or if the breakpoint
9801        # is in a postponed file (we'll do postponed ones
9802        # later).
9803        next unless %dbline or $postponed_file{$file};
9804
9805        # In an eval. This is a little harder, so we'll
9806        # do more processing on that below.
9807        ( push @hard, $file ), next
9808          if $file =~ /^\(\w*eval/;
9809
9810        # XXX I have no idea what this is doing. Yet.
9811        my @add;
9812        @add = %{ $postponed_file{$file} }
9813          if $postponed_file{$file};
9814
9815        # Save the list of all the breakpoints for this file.
9816        set_list( "PERLDB_FILE_$_", %dbline, @add );
9817
9818        # Serialize the extra data %breakpoints_data hash.
9819        # That's a bug fix.
9820        set_list( "PERLDB_FILE_ENABLED_$_",
9821            map { _is_breakpoint_enabled($file, $_) ? 1 : 0 }
9822            sort { $a <=> $b } keys(%dbline)
9823        )
9824    } ## end for (0 .. $#had_breakpoints)
9825
9826    # The breakpoint was inside an eval. This is a little
9827    # more difficult. XXX and I don't understand it.
9828    foreach my $hard_file (@hard) {
9829        # Get over to the eval in question.
9830        *dbline = $main::{ '_<' . $hard_file };
9831        my $quoted = quotemeta $hard_file;
9832        my %subs;
9833        for my $sub ( keys %sub ) {
9834            if (my ($n1, $n2) = $sub{$sub} =~ /\A$quoted:(\d+)-(\d+)\z/) {
9835                $subs{$sub} = [ $n1, $n2 ];
9836            }
9837        }
9838        unless (%subs) {
9839            print {$OUT}
9840            "No subroutines in $hard_file, ignoring breakpoints.\n";
9841            next;
9842        }
9843        LINES: foreach my $line ( keys %dbline ) {
9844
9845            # One breakpoint per sub only:
9846            my ( $offset, $found );
9847            SUBS: foreach my $sub ( keys %subs ) {
9848                if (
9849                    $subs{$sub}->[1] >= $line    # Not after the subroutine
9850                    and (
9851                        not defined $offset    # Not caught
9852                            or $offset < 0
9853                    )
9854                )
9855                {                              # or badly caught
9856                    $found  = $sub;
9857                    $offset = $line - $subs{$sub}->[0];
9858                    if ($offset >= 0) {
9859                        $offset = "+$offset";
9860                        last SUBS;
9861                    }
9862                } ## end if ($subs{$sub}->[1] >=...
9863            } ## end for $sub (keys %subs)
9864            if ( defined $offset ) {
9865                $postponed{$found} =
9866                "break $offset if $dbline{$line}";
9867            }
9868            else {
9869                print {$OUT}
9870                ("Breakpoint in ${hard_file}:$line ignored:"
9871                . " after all the subroutines.\n");
9872            }
9873        } ## end for $line (keys %dbline)
9874    } ## end for (@hard)
9875
9876    # Save the other things that don't need to be
9877    # processed.
9878    set_list( "PERLDB_POSTPONE",  %postponed );
9879    set_list( "PERLDB_PRETYPE",   @$pretype );
9880    set_list( "PERLDB_PRE",       @$pre );
9881    set_list( "PERLDB_POST",      @$post );
9882    set_list( "PERLDB_TYPEAHEAD", @typeahead );
9883
9884    # We are officially restarting.
9885    $ENV{PERLDB_RESTART} = 1;
9886
9887    # We are junking all child debuggers.
9888    delete $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS};    # Restore ini state
9889
9890    # Set this back to the initial pid.
9891    $ENV{PERLDB_PIDS} = $ini_pids if defined $ini_pids;
9892
9893=pod
9894
9895After all the debugger status has been saved, we take the command we built up
9896and then return it, so we can C<exec()> it. The debugger will spot the
9897C<PERLDB_RESTART> environment variable and realize it needs to reload its state
9898from the environment.
9899
9900=cut
9901
9902    # And run Perl again. Add the "-d" flag, all the
9903    # flags we built up, the script (whether a one-liner
9904    # or a file), add on the -emacs flag for a slave editor,
9905    # and then the old arguments.
9906
9907    return ($^X, '-d', @flags, @script, ($slave_editor ? '-emacs' : ()), @ARGS);
9908
9909};  # end restart
9910
9911=back
9912
9913=head1 END PROCESSING - THE C<END> BLOCK
9914
9915Come here at the very end of processing. We want to go into a
9916loop where we allow the user to enter commands and interact with the
9917debugger, but we don't want anything else to execute.
9918
9919First we set the C<$finished> variable, so that some commands that
9920shouldn't be run after the end of program quit working.
9921
9922We then figure out whether we're truly done (as in the user entered a C<q>
9923command, or we finished execution while running nonstop). If we aren't,
9924we set C<$single> to 1 (causing the debugger to get control again).
9925
9926We then call C<DB::fake::at_exit()>, which returns the C<Use 'q' to quit ...>
9927message and returns control to the debugger. Repeat.
9928
9929When the user finally enters a C<q> command, C<$fall_off_end> is set to
99301 and the C<END> block simply exits with C<$single> set to 0 (don't
9931break, run to completion.).
9932
9933=cut
9934
9935END {
9936    $finished = 1 if $inhibit_exit;    # So that some commands may be disabled.
9937    $fall_off_end = 1 unless $inhibit_exit;
9938
9939    # Do not stop in at_exit() and destructors on exit:
9940    if ($fall_off_end or $runnonstop) {
9941        save_hist();
9942    } else {
9943        $DB::single = 1;
9944        DB::fake::at_exit();
9945    }
9946} ## end END
9947
9948=head1 PRE-5.8 COMMANDS
9949
9950Some of the commands changed function quite a bit in the 5.8 command
9951realignment, so much so that the old code had to be replaced completely.
9952Because we wanted to retain the option of being able to go back to the
9953former command set, we moved the old code off to this section.
9954
9955There's an awful lot of duplicated code here. We've duplicated the
9956comments to keep things clear.
9957
9958=head2 Null command
9959
9960Does nothing. Used to I<turn off> commands.
9961
9962=cut
9963
9964sub cmd_pre580_null {
9965
9966    # do nothing...
9967}
9968
9969=head2 Old C<a> command.
9970
9971This version added actions if you supplied them, and deleted them
9972if you didn't.
9973
9974=cut
9975
9976sub cmd_pre580_a {
9977    my $xcmd = shift;
9978    my $cmd  = shift;
9979
9980    # Argument supplied. Add the action.
9981    if ( $cmd =~ /^(\d*)\s*(.*)/ ) {
9982
9983        # If the line isn't there, use the current line.
9984        my $i = $1 || $line;
9985        my $j = $2;
9986
9987        # If there is an action ...
9988        if ( length $j ) {
9989
9990            # ... but the line isn't breakable, skip it.
9991            if ( $dbline[$i] == 0 ) {
9992                print $OUT "Line $i may not have an action.\n";
9993            }
9994            else {
9995
9996                # ... and the line is breakable:
9997                # Mark that there's an action in this file.
9998                $had_breakpoints{$filename} |= 2;
9999
10000                # Delete any current action.
10001                $dbline{$i} =~ s/\0[^\0]*//;
10002
10003                # Add the new action, continuing the line as needed.
10004                $dbline{$i} .= "\0" . action($j);
10005            }
10006        } ## end if (length $j)
10007
10008        # No action supplied.
10009        else {
10010
10011            # Delete the action.
10012            $dbline{$i} =~ s/\0[^\0]*//;
10013
10014            # Mark as having no break or action if nothing's left.
10015            delete $dbline{$i} if $dbline{$i} eq '';
10016        }
10017    } ## end if ($cmd =~ /^(\d*)\s*(.*)/)
10018} ## end sub cmd_pre580_a
10019
10020=head2 Old C<b> command
10021
10022Add breakpoints.
10023
10024=cut
10025
10026sub cmd_pre580_b {
10027    my $xcmd   = shift;
10028    my $cmd    = shift;
10029    my $dbline = shift;
10030
10031    # Break on load.
10032    if ( $cmd =~ /^load\b\s*(.*)/ ) {
10033        my $file = $1;
10034        $file =~ s/\s+$//;
10035        cmd_b_load($file);
10036    }
10037
10038    # b compile|postpone <some sub> [<condition>]
10039    # The interpreter actually traps this one for us; we just put the
10040    # necessary condition in the %postponed hash.
10041    elsif ( $cmd =~ /^(postpone|compile)\b\s*([':A-Za-z_][':\w]*)\s*(.*)/ ) {
10042
10043        # Capture the condition if there is one. Make it true if none.
10044        my $cond = length $3 ? $3 : '1';
10045
10046        # Save the sub name and set $break to 1 if $1 was 'postpone', 0
10047        # if it was 'compile'.
10048        my ( $subname, $break ) = ( $2, $1 eq 'postpone' );
10049
10050        # De-Perl4-ify the name - ' separators to ::.
10051        $subname =~ s/\'/::/g;
10052
10053        # Qualify it into the current package unless it's already qualified.
10054        $subname = "${package}::" . $subname
10055          unless $subname =~ /::/;
10056
10057        # Add main if it starts with ::.
10058        $subname = "main" . $subname if substr( $subname, 0, 2 ) eq "::";
10059
10060        # Save the break type for this sub.
10061        $postponed{$subname} = $break ? "break +0 if $cond" : "compile";
10062    } ## end elsif ($cmd =~ ...
10063
10064    # b <sub name> [<condition>]
10065    elsif ( $cmd =~ /^([':A-Za-z_][':\w]*(?:\[.*\])?)\s*(.*)/ ) {
10066        my $subname = $1;
10067        my $cond = length $2 ? $2 : '1';
10068        cmd_b_sub( $subname, $cond );
10069    }
10070    # b <line> [<condition>].
10071    elsif ( $cmd =~ /^(\d*)\s*(.*)/ ) {
10072        my $i = $1 || $dbline;
10073        my $cond = length $2 ? $2 : '1';
10074        cmd_b_line( $i, $cond );
10075    }
10076} ## end sub cmd_pre580_b
10077
10078=head2 Old C<D> command.
10079
10080Delete all breakpoints unconditionally.
10081
10082=cut
10083
10084sub cmd_pre580_D {
10085    my $xcmd = shift;
10086    my $cmd  = shift;
10087    if ( $cmd =~ /^\s*$/ ) {
10088        print $OUT "Deleting all breakpoints...\n";
10089
10090        # %had_breakpoints lists every file that had at least one
10091        # breakpoint in it.
10092        my $file;
10093        for $file ( keys %had_breakpoints ) {
10094
10095            # Switch to the desired file temporarily.
10096            local *dbline = $main::{ '_<' . $file };
10097
10098            $max = $#dbline;
10099            my $was;
10100
10101            # For all lines in this file ...
10102            for my $i (1 .. $max) {
10103
10104                # If there's a breakpoint or action on this line ...
10105                if ( defined $dbline{$i} ) {
10106
10107                    # ... remove the breakpoint.
10108                    $dbline{$i} =~ s/^[^\0]+//;
10109                    if ( $dbline{$i} =~ s/^\0?$// ) {
10110
10111                        # Remove the entry altogether if no action is there.
10112                        delete $dbline{$i};
10113                    }
10114                } ## end if (defined $dbline{$i...
10115            } ## end for my $i (1 .. $max)
10116
10117            # If, after we turn off the "there were breakpoints in this file"
10118            # bit, the entry in %had_breakpoints for this file is zero,
10119            # we should remove this file from the hash.
10120            if ( not $had_breakpoints{$file} &= ~1 ) {
10121                delete $had_breakpoints{$file};
10122            }
10123        } ## end for $file (keys %had_breakpoints)
10124
10125        # Kill off all the other breakpoints that are waiting for files that
10126        # haven't been loaded yet.
10127        undef %postponed;
10128        undef %postponed_file;
10129        undef %break_on_load;
10130    } ## end if ($cmd =~ /^\s*$/)
10131} ## end sub cmd_pre580_D
10132
10133=head2 Old C<h> command
10134
10135Print help. Defaults to printing the long-form help; the 5.8 version
10136prints the summary by default.
10137
10138=cut
10139
10140sub cmd_pre580_h {
10141    my $xcmd = shift;
10142    my $cmd  = shift;
10143
10144    # Print the *right* help, long format.
10145    if ( $cmd =~ /^\s*$/ ) {
10146        print_help($pre580_help);
10147    }
10148
10149    # 'h h' - explicitly-requested summary.
10150    elsif ( $cmd =~ /^h\s*/ ) {
10151        print_help($pre580_summary);
10152    }
10153
10154    # Find and print a command's help.
10155    elsif ( $cmd =~ /^h\s+(\S.*)$/ ) {
10156        my $asked  = $1;                   # for proper errmsg
10157        my $qasked = quotemeta($asked);    # for searching
10158                                           # XXX: finds CR but not <CR>
10159        if (
10160            $pre580_help =~ /^
10161                              <?           # Optional '<'
10162                              (?:[IB]<)    # Optional markup
10163                              $qasked      # The command name
10164                            /mx
10165          )
10166        {
10167
10168            while (
10169                $pre580_help =~ /^
10170                                  (             # The command help:
10171                                   <?           # Optional '<'
10172                                   (?:[IB]<)    # Optional markup
10173                                   $qasked      # The command name
10174                                   ([\s\S]*?)   # Lines starting with tabs
10175                                   \n           # Final newline
10176                                  )
10177                                  (?!\s)/mgx
10178              )    # Line not starting with space
10179                   # (Next command's help)
10180            {
10181                print_help($1);
10182            }
10183        } ## end if ($pre580_help =~ /^<?(?:[IB]<)$qasked/m)
10184
10185        # Help not found.
10186        else {
10187            print_help("B<$asked> is not a debugger command.\n");
10188        }
10189    } ## end elsif ($cmd =~ /^h\s+(\S.*)$/)
10190} ## end sub cmd_pre580_h
10191
10192=head2 Old C<W> command
10193
10194C<W E<lt>exprE<gt>> adds a watch expression, C<W> deletes them all.
10195
10196=cut
10197
10198sub cmd_pre580_W {
10199    my $xcmd = shift;
10200    my $cmd  = shift;
10201
10202    # Delete all watch expressions.
10203    if ( $cmd =~ /^$/ ) {
10204
10205        # No watching is going on.
10206        $trace &= ~2;
10207
10208        # Kill all the watch expressions and values.
10209        @to_watch = @old_watch = ();
10210    }
10211
10212    # Add a watch expression.
10213    elsif ( $cmd =~ /^(.*)/s ) {
10214
10215        # add it to the list to be watched.
10216        push @to_watch, $1;
10217
10218        # Get the current value of the expression.
10219        # Doesn't handle expressions returning list values!
10220        $evalarg = $1;
10221        # The &-call is here to ascertain the mutability of @_.
10222        my ($val) = &DB::eval;
10223        $val = ( defined $val ) ? "'$val'" : 'undef';
10224
10225        # Save it.
10226        push @old_watch, $val;
10227
10228        # We're watching stuff.
10229        $trace |= 2;
10230
10231    } ## end elsif ($cmd =~ /^(.*)/s)
10232} ## end sub cmd_pre580_W
10233
10234=head1 PRE-AND-POST-PROMPT COMMANDS AND ACTIONS
10235
10236The debugger used to have a bunch of nearly-identical code to handle
10237the pre-and-post-prompt action commands. C<cmd_pre590_prepost> and
10238C<cmd_prepost> unify all this into one set of code to handle the
10239appropriate actions.
10240
10241=head2 C<cmd_pre590_prepost>
10242
10243A small wrapper around C<cmd_prepost>; it makes sure that the default doesn't
10244do something destructive. In pre 5.8 debuggers, the default action was to
10245delete all the actions.
10246
10247=cut
10248
10249sub cmd_pre590_prepost {
10250    my $cmd    = shift;
10251    my $line   = shift || '*';
10252    my $dbline = shift;
10253
10254    return cmd_prepost( $cmd, $line, $dbline );
10255} ## end sub cmd_pre590_prepost
10256
10257=head2 C<cmd_prepost>
10258
10259Actually does all the handling for C<E<lt>>, C<E<gt>>, C<{{>, C<{>, etc.
10260Since the lists of actions are all held in arrays that are pointed to by
10261references anyway, all we have to do is pick the right array reference and
10262then use generic code to all, delete, or list actions.
10263
10264=cut
10265
10266sub cmd_prepost {
10267    my $cmd = shift;
10268
10269    # No action supplied defaults to 'list'.
10270    my $line = shift || '?';
10271
10272    # Figure out what to put in the prompt.
10273    my $which = '';
10274
10275    # Make sure we have some array or another to address later.
10276    # This means that if for some reason the tests fail, we won't be
10277    # trying to stash actions or delete them from the wrong place.
10278    my $aref = [];
10279
10280    # < - Perl code to run before prompt.
10281    if ( $cmd =~ /^\</o ) {
10282        $which = 'pre-perl';
10283        $aref  = $pre;
10284    }
10285
10286    # > - Perl code to run after prompt.
10287    elsif ( $cmd =~ /^\>/o ) {
10288        $which = 'post-perl';
10289        $aref  = $post;
10290    }
10291
10292    # { - first check for properly-balanced braces.
10293    elsif ( $cmd =~ /^\{/o ) {
10294        if ( $cmd =~ /^\{.*\}$/o && unbalanced( substr( $cmd, 1 ) ) ) {
10295            print $OUT
10296"$cmd is now a debugger command\nuse ';$cmd' if you mean Perl code\n";
10297        }
10298
10299        # Properly balanced. Pre-prompt debugger actions.
10300        else {
10301            $which = 'pre-debugger';
10302            $aref  = $pretype;
10303        }
10304    } ## end elsif ( $cmd =~ /^\{/o )
10305
10306    # Did we find something that makes sense?
10307    unless ($which) {
10308        print $OUT "Confused by command: $cmd\n";
10309    }
10310
10311    # Yes.
10312    else {
10313
10314        # List actions.
10315        if ( $line =~ /^\s*\?\s*$/o ) {
10316            unless (@$aref) {
10317
10318                # Nothing there. Complain.
10319                print $OUT "No $which actions.\n";
10320            }
10321            else {
10322
10323                # List the actions in the selected list.
10324                print $OUT "$which commands:\n";
10325                foreach my $action (@$aref) {
10326                    print $OUT "\t$cmd -- $action\n";
10327                }
10328            } ## end else
10329        } ## end if ( $line =~ /^\s*\?\s*$/o)
10330
10331        # Might be a delete.
10332        else {
10333            if ( length($cmd) == 1 ) {
10334                if ( $line =~ /^\s*\*\s*$/o ) {
10335
10336                    # It's a delete. Get rid of the old actions in the
10337                    # selected list..
10338                    @$aref = ();
10339                    print $OUT "All $cmd actions cleared.\n";
10340                }
10341                else {
10342
10343                    # Replace all the actions. (This is a <, >, or {).
10344                    @$aref = action($line);
10345                }
10346            } ## end if ( length($cmd) == 1)
10347            elsif ( length($cmd) == 2 ) {
10348
10349                # Add the action to the line. (This is a <<, >>, or {{).
10350                push @$aref, action($line);
10351            }
10352            else {
10353
10354                # <<<, >>>>, {{{{{{ ... something not a command.
10355                print $OUT
10356                  "Confused by strange length of $which command($cmd)...\n";
10357            }
10358        } ## end else [ if ( $line =~ /^\s*\?\s*$/o)
10359    } ## end else
10360} ## end sub cmd_prepost
10361
10362=head1 C<DB::fake>
10363
10364Contains the C<at_exit> routine that the debugger uses to issue the
10365C<Debugged program terminated ...> message after the program completes. See
10366the C<END> block documentation for more details.
10367
10368=cut
10369
10370package DB::fake;
10371
10372sub at_exit {
10373    "Debugged program terminated.  Use 'q' to quit or 'R' to restart.";
10374}
10375
10376package DB;    # Do not trace this 1; below!
10377
103781;
10379
10380
10381